elf32-ppc.c revision 1.1.1.10 1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1994-2024 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the
19 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22 /* The assembler should generate a full set of section symbols even
23 when they appear unused. The linux kernel build tool recordmcount
24 needs them. */
25 #define TARGET_KEEP_UNUSED_SECTION_SYMBOLS true
26
27 #include "sysdep.h"
28 #include <stdarg.h>
29 #include "bfd.h"
30 #include "bfdlink.h"
31 #include "libbfd.h"
32 #include "elf-bfd.h"
33 #include "elf/ppc.h"
34 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
35 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
36 #include "dwarf2.h"
37 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
38
39 /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1. */
40 #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
41
42 typedef enum split16_format_type
43 {
44 split16a_type = 0,
45 split16d_type
46 }
47 split16_format_type;
48
49 /* RELA relocations are used here. */
50
51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
52 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
54 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
55
56 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
57 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
58 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
59 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
60 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
61 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
62
63 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
64 section. */
65 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
66
67 /* For old-style PLT. */
68 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
69 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
70
71 /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
72 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
73 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
74 ((4*4 \
75 + (h != NULL \
76 && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
77 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
78 + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
79 & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
80
81 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
82
83 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
84 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
85 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
86 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
87 {
88 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
89 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
90 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
91 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
92 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
93 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
94 0x60000000, /* nop */
95 0x60000000, /* nop */
96 };
97 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
98 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
99 {
100 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
101 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
102 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
103 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
104 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
105 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
106 0x60000000, /* nop */
107 0x60000000, /* nop */
108 };
109
110 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
111 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
112 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
113 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
114 {
115 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
116 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
117 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
118 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
119 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
120 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
121 0x60000000, /* nop */
122 0x60000000, /* nop */
123 };
124 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
125 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
126 {
127 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
128 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
129 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
130 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
131 0x60000000, /* nop */
132 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 0x60000000, /* nop */
134 0x60000000, /* nop */
135 };
136
137 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
138 .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
139
140 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
141 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
142 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
143 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
144 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
145 a shared library. */
146 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
147
148 /* Some instructions. */
149 #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
150 #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
151 #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
152 #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
153 #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
154 #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
155 #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
156 #define B 0x48000000
157 #define BA 0x48000002
158 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
159 #define BCTR 0x4e800420
160 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
161 #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
162 #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
163 #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
164 #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
165 #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
166 #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
167 #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
168 #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
169 #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
170 #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
171 #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
172 #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
173 #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
174 #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
175 #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
176 #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
177 #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
178 #define NOP 0x60000000
179 #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
180
181 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
182 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
183 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
184
185 /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
186 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
187 ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
188 + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
189 + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
190
191 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
193 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
194 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
195 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
196 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
197 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
198 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
199 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
200 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
201 complain, special_func) \
202 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
203 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
204 #type, false, 0, mask, pc_relative)
205
206 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
207
208 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
209 /* This reloc does nothing. */
210 HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
211 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
212
213 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
214 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
215 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
216
217 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
218 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
219 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, false, signed,
220 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
221
222 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
223 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
224 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
225
226 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
227 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
228 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
229
230 /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
231 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
232 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
233
234 /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
235 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
236 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
237 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
238
239 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
240 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
241 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
242 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
243
244 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
245 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
246 bits must be zero. */
247 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
248 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
249
250 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
251 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
252 two bits must be zero. */
253 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
254 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
255
256 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
257 HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
258 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
259
260 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
261 HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
262 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
263
264 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
265 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
266 zero. */
267 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
268 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
269
270 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
271 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
272 be zero. */
273 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
274 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
275
276 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
277 symbol. */
278 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
279 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
280
281 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
282 the symbol. */
283 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
284 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
285
286 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
287 the symbol. */
288 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
289 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
290
291 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
292 the symbol. */
293 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
294 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
295
296 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
297 entry for the symbol. */
298 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
299 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
300
301 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
302 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
303 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
304 shared library into the object, because the object being
305 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
306 HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
307 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
308
309 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
310 entries. */
311 HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
312 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
313
314 /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
315 HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
316 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
317
318 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
319 longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
320 addend. */
321 HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
322 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
323
324 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
325 object rather than the final value. Normally used for
326 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
327 HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
328 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
329
330 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
331 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
332 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
333
334 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
335 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
336 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
337
338 /* 32-bit PC relative */
339 HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, true, dont,
340 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
341
342 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
343 FIXME: not supported. */
344 HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
345 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
346
347 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
348 FIXME: not supported. */
349 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 4, 32, 0, 0, true, dont,
350 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
351
352 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
353 the symbol. */
354 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
355 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
356
357 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
358 the symbol. */
359 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
360 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
361
362 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
363 the symbol. */
364 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
365 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
366
367 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
368 small data items. */
369 HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
370 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
371
372 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
373 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
374 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
375
376 /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
377 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
378 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
379
380 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
381 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
382 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
383
384 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
385 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
386 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
387
388 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
389 HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
390 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391
392 HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
393 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394
395 HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
396 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
397
398 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
399 HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
400 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401
402 HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
403 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
404
405 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
406 definition of its TLS sym. */
407 HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
408 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
409
410 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
411 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
412 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
413 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
414 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
415
416 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
417 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
418 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
419
420 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
421 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
422 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
423
424 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
425 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
426 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
427
428 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
429 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
430 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
431
432 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
433 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
434 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
435 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
436
437 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
438 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
439 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
440
441 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
442 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
443 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
444
445 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
446 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
447 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
448
449 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
450 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
451 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
452
453 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
454 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
455 to the first entry. */
456 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
457 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
458
459 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
460 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
461 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
462
463 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
464 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
465 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
466
467 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
468 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
469 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
470
471 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
472 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
473 first entry. */
474 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
475 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
476
477 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
478 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
479 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
480
481 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
482 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
483 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
484
485 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
486 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
487 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
488
489 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
490 the offset to the entry. */
491 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
492 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
493
494 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
495 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
496 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
497
498 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
499 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
500 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
501
502 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
503 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
504 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
505
506 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
507 offset to the entry. */
508 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
509 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
510
511 /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
512 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
513 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
514
515 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
516 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
517 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
518
519 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
520 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
521 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
522
523 /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
524 in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
525
526 /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
527 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
528 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
529
530 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
531 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
532 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
533
534 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
535 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
536 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
537
538 /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
539 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
540 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
541
542 /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
543 plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
544 is negative. */
545 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
546 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
547
548 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
549 address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
550 _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
551 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
552 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
553
554 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
555 address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
556 _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
557 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
558 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
559
560 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
561 small data items. */
562 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
563 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
564
565 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
566 signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
567 field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
568 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
569 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
570
571 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
572 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
573 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
574 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
575 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
576 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
577
578 /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
579 in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
580 register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
581 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
582 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
583
584 /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
585 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 2, 8, 0xff, 1, true, signed,
586 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
587
588 /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
589 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 4, 16, 0xfffe, 0, true, signed,
590 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
591
592 /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
593 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 4, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, true, signed,
594 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
595
596 /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
597 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
598 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
599
600 /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
601 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
602 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
603
604 /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
605 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
606 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
607
608 /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
609 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
610 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
611
612 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
613 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
614 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
615
616 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
617 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
618 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
619
620 /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
621 instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
622 the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
623 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
624 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
625
626 /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
627 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
628 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
629
630 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
631 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
632 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
633
634 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
635 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
636 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
637
638 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
639 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
640 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
641
642 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
643 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
644 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
645
646 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
647 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
648 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
649
650 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
651 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
652 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
653
654 /* e_li split20 format. */
655 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 4, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, false, dont,
656 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
659 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
660
661 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
662 HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, signed,
663 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
664
665 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
666 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, dont,
667 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
668
669 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
670 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
671 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
672
673 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
674 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
675 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
676 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
677
678 /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
679 HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, true, signed,
680 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
681
682 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
683 HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, false, signed,
684 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
685
686 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
687 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
688 NULL),
689
690 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
691 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
692 NULL),
693
694 /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
695 HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
696 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
697 };
698
699 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
701
702 static void
703 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
704 {
705 unsigned int i, type;
706
707 for (i = 0;
708 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
709 i++)
710 {
711 type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
712 if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
713 / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
714 abort ();
715 ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
716 }
717 }
718
719 static reloc_howto_type *
720 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
721 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
722 {
723 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
724
725 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
726 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
727 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
728
729 switch (code)
730 {
731 default:
732 return NULL;
733
734 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
735 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
736 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
737 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
738 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
739 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
740 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
741 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
742 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
743 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
744 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
745 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
746 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
747 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
748 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
749 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
750 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
751 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
752 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
753 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
754 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
755 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
756 case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
757 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
758 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
759 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
760 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
761 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
762 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
763 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
764 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
765 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
766 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
767 case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
768 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
769 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
770 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
771 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
772 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
773 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
774 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
775 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
776 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
777 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
778 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
779 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
780 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
781 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
782 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
783 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
784 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
785 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
786 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
787 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
788 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
789 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
790 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
791 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
792 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
793 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
794 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
795 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
796 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
797 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
798 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
799 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
800 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
801 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
802 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
803 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
804 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
805 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
806 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
807 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
808 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
809 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
810 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
811 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
812 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
813 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
814 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
815 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
816 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
817 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
818 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
819 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
820 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
821 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
822 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
823 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
824 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
825 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
826 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
827 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
828 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
829 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
830 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
831 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
832 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
833 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
834 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
835 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
836 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
837 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
838 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
839 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
840 break;
841 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
842 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
843 break;
844 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
845 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
846 break;
847 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
848 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
849 break;
850 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
851 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
852 break;
853 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
854 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
855 break;
856 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
857 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
858 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
859 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
860 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
861 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
862 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
863 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
864 }
865
866 return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
867 };
868
869 static reloc_howto_type *
870 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
871 const char *r_name)
872 {
873 unsigned int i;
874
875 for (i = 0;
876 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
877 i++)
878 if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
879 && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
880 return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
881
882 return NULL;
883 }
884
885 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
886
887 static bool
888 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
889 arelent *cache_ptr,
890 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
891 {
892 unsigned int r_type;
893
894 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
895 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
896 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
897
898 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
899 if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
900 {
901 /* xgettext:c-format */
902 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
903 abfd, r_type);
904 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
905 return false;
906 }
907
908 cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
909
910 /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
911 ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
912 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
913 {
914 /* xgettext:c-format */
915 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
916 abfd, r_type);
917 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
918
919 return false;
920 }
921
922 return true;
923 }
924
925 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
926
927 static bfd_reloc_status_type
928 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
929 arelent *reloc_entry,
930 asymbol *symbol,
931 void *data,
932 asection *input_section,
933 bfd *output_bfd,
934 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
935 {
936 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
937 long insn;
938 bfd_size_type octets;
939 bfd_vma value;
940
941 if (output_bfd != NULL)
942 {
943 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
944 return bfd_reloc_ok;
945 }
946
947 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
948 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
949 if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
950 return bfd_reloc_continue;
951
952 value = 0;
953 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
954 value = symbol->value;
955 value += (reloc_entry->addend
956 + symbol->section->output_offset
957 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
958 value -= (reloc_entry->address
959 + input_section->output_offset
960 + input_section->output_section->vma);
961 value >>= 16;
962
963 octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
964 if (!bfd_reloc_offset_in_range (reloc_entry->howto, abfd,
965 input_section, octets))
966 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
967
968 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
969 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
970 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
971 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
972 return bfd_reloc_ok;
973 }
974
975 static bfd_reloc_status_type
976 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
977 arelent *reloc_entry,
978 asymbol *symbol,
979 void *data,
980 asection *input_section,
981 bfd *output_bfd,
982 char **error_message)
983 {
984 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
985 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
986 link time. */
987 if (output_bfd != NULL)
988 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
989 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
990
991 if (error_message != NULL)
992 *error_message = bfd_asprintf (_("generic linker can't handle %s"),
993 reloc_entry->howto->name);
994 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
995 }
996
997 /* Sections created by the linker. */
999
1000 typedef struct elf_linker_section
1001 {
1002 /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
1003 asection *section;
1004 /* Section name. */
1005 const char *name;
1006 /* Associated bss section name. */
1007 const char *bss_name;
1008 /* Associated symbol name. */
1009 const char *sym_name;
1010 /* Associated symbol. */
1011 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1012 } elf_linker_section_t;
1013
1014 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1015 symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1016 based on different addend's. */
1017
1018 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1019 {
1020 /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1021 struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1022 /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1023 bfd_vma offset;
1024 /* addend used */
1025 bfd_vma addend;
1026 /* which linker section this is */
1027 elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1028 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1029
1030 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1031 {
1032 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1033
1034 /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1035 sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1036 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1037
1038 /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1039 unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1040 unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1041 };
1042
1043 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1044 ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1045
1046 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1047 (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1048
1049 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1050 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1051 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1052
1053 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1054
1055 static bool
1056 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1057 {
1058 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata));
1059 }
1060
1061 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1062
1063 bool
1064 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1065 {
1066 unsigned long mach = 0;
1067 asection *s;
1068 unsigned char *contents;
1069
1070 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1071 && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1072 {
1073
1074 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1075 if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1076 break;
1077 if (s != NULL)
1078 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1079 }
1080
1081 if (mach == 0)
1082 {
1083 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1084 if (s != NULL
1085 && s->size >= 24
1086 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0
1087 && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1088 {
1089 unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1090 unsigned int i;
1091
1092 for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1093 {
1094 unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1095 switch (val >> 16)
1096 {
1097 case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1098 case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1099 if (mach == 0)
1100 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1101 break;
1102
1103 case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1104 case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1105 if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1106 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1107 break;
1108
1109 case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1110 case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1111 case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1112 if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1113 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1114 break;
1115
1116 case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1117 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1118 break;
1119
1120 default:
1121 mach = -1ul;
1122 }
1123 }
1124 free (contents);
1125 }
1126 }
1127
1128 if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1129 {
1130 const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1131
1132 for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1133 if (arch->mach == mach)
1134 {
1135 abfd->arch_info = arch;
1136 break;
1137 }
1138 }
1139 return true;
1140 }
1141
1142 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1143 default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1144
1145 static bool
1146 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1147 {
1148 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1149 return true;
1150
1151 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1152 {
1153 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1154
1155 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1156 {
1157 /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1158 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1159 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1160 }
1161 }
1162 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1163 }
1164
1165 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1166
1167 static bool
1168 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1169 {
1170 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1171 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1172
1173 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1174 elf_flags_init (abfd) = true;
1175 return true;
1176 }
1177
1178 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1179
1180 static bool
1181 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1182 {
1183 int offset;
1184 unsigned int size;
1185
1186 switch (note->descsz)
1187 {
1188 default:
1189 return false;
1190
1191 case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1192 /* pr_cursig */
1193 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1194
1195 /* pr_pid */
1196 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1197
1198 /* pr_reg */
1199 offset = 72;
1200 size = 192;
1201
1202 break;
1203 }
1204
1205 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1206 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1207 size, note->descpos + offset);
1208 }
1209
1210 static bool
1211 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1212 {
1213 switch (note->descsz)
1214 {
1215 default:
1216 return false;
1217
1218 case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1219 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1220 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1221 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1222 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1223 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1224 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1225 }
1226
1227 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1228 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1229 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1230
1231 {
1232 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1233 int n = strlen (command);
1234
1235 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1236 command[n - 1] = '\0';
1237 }
1238
1239 return true;
1240 }
1241
1242 static char *
1243 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1244 {
1245 switch (note_type)
1246 {
1247 default:
1248 return NULL;
1249
1250 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1251 {
1252 char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1253 va_list ap;
1254
1255 va_start (ap, note_type);
1256 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1257 strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1258 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1259 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1260 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1261 -Wstringop-truncation:
1262 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1263 */
1264 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1265 #endif
1266 strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1267 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1268 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1269 #endif
1270 va_end (ap);
1271 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1272 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1273 }
1274
1275 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1276 {
1277 char data[268];
1278 va_list ap;
1279 long pid;
1280 int cursig;
1281 const void *greg;
1282
1283 va_start (ap, note_type);
1284 memset (data, 0, 72);
1285 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1286 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1287 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1288 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1289 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1290 memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1291 memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1292 va_end (ap);
1293 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1294 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1295 }
1296 }
1297 }
1298
1299 static flagword
1300 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1301 {
1302
1303 if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1304 return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1305
1306 return 0;
1307 }
1308
1309 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1310 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1311
1312 static bfd_vma
1313 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1314 const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1315 const arelent *rel)
1316 {
1317 return rel->address;
1318 }
1319
1320 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1321 is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1322 type. */
1323
1324 static bool
1325 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1326 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1327 const char *name,
1328 int shindex)
1329 {
1330 asection *newsect;
1331 flagword flags;
1332
1333 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1334 return false;
1335
1336 newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1337 flags = 0;
1338 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1339 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1340
1341 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1342 flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1343
1344 if (startswith (name, ".PPC.EMB"))
1345 name += 8;
1346 if (startswith (name, ".sbss")
1347 || startswith (name, ".sdata"))
1348 flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
1349
1350 return (flags == 0
1351 || bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, newsect->flags | flags));
1352 }
1353
1354 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1355
1356 static bool
1357 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1358 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1359 asection *asect)
1360 {
1361 if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1362 shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1363
1364 return true;
1365 }
1366
1367 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1368 need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1369
1370 static int
1371 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1372 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1373 {
1374 asection *s;
1375 int ret = 0;
1376
1377 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1378 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1379 ++ret;
1380
1381 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1382 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1383 ++ret;
1384
1385 return ret;
1386 }
1387
1388 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1389
1390 bool
1391 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1392 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1393 {
1394 struct elf_segment_map *m;
1395
1396 /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1397 LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1398 there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1399 If we find that case, we split the segment.
1400 We maintain the original output section order. */
1401
1402 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1403 {
1404 struct elf_segment_map *n;
1405 size_t amt;
1406 unsigned int j, k;
1407 unsigned int p_flags;
1408
1409 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1410 continue;
1411
1412 for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1413 {
1414 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1415 p_flags |= PF_W;
1416 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1417 {
1418 p_flags |= PF_X;
1419 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1420 p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1421 break;
1422 }
1423 }
1424 if (j != m->count)
1425 while (++j != m->count)
1426 {
1427 unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1428
1429 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1430 p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1431 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1432 {
1433 p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1434 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1435 p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1436 if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1437 break;
1438 }
1439 p_flags |= p_flags1;
1440 }
1441 /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1442 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1443 two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1444 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1445 if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1446 {
1447 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1448 m->p_flags = p_flags;
1449 }
1450 if (j == m->count)
1451 continue;
1452
1453 /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1454 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1455 The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1456
1457 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1458 amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1459 n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1460 if (n == NULL)
1461 return false;
1462
1463 n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1464 n->count = m->count - j;
1465 for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1466 n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1467 m->count = j;
1468 m->p_size_valid = 0;
1469 n->next = m->next;
1470 m->next = n;
1471 }
1472
1473 return true;
1474 }
1475
1476 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1477 .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1478 that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1479 2 sections. */
1480
1481 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1482 {
1483 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1484 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1485 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1486 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1487 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1488 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1489 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1490 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1491 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1492 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1493 };
1494
1495 /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1496 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1497 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1498
1499 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1500 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1501 {
1502 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1503
1504 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1505 if (sec->name == NULL)
1506 return NULL;
1507
1508 ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1509 sec->use_rela_p);
1510 if (ssect != NULL)
1511 {
1512 if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1513 ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1514 return ssect;
1515 }
1516
1517 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1518 }
1519
1520 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1522 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1523 {
1524 struct apuinfo_list *next;
1525 unsigned long value;
1526 }
1527 apuinfo_list;
1528
1529 static apuinfo_list *head;
1530 static bool apuinfo_set;
1531
1532 static void
1533 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1534 {
1535 head = NULL;
1536 apuinfo_set = false;
1537 }
1538
1539 static void
1540 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1541 {
1542 apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1543
1544 while (entry != NULL)
1545 {
1546 if (entry->value == value)
1547 return;
1548 entry = entry->next;
1549 }
1550
1551 entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1552 if (entry == NULL)
1553 return;
1554
1555 entry->value = value;
1556 entry->next = head;
1557 head = entry;
1558 }
1559
1560 static unsigned
1561 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1562 {
1563 apuinfo_list *entry;
1564 unsigned long count;
1565
1566 for (entry = head, count = 0;
1567 entry;
1568 entry = entry->next)
1569 ++ count;
1570
1571 return count;
1572 }
1573
1574 static inline unsigned long
1575 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1576 {
1577 apuinfo_list * entry;
1578
1579 for (entry = head;
1580 entry && number --;
1581 entry = entry->next)
1582 ;
1583
1584 return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1585 }
1586
1587 static void
1588 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1589 {
1590 apuinfo_list *entry;
1591
1592 for (entry = head; entry;)
1593 {
1594 apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1595 free (entry);
1596 entry = next;
1597 }
1598
1599 head = NULL;
1600 }
1601
1602 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1603 the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1604
1605 static void
1606 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1607 {
1608 bfd *ibfd;
1609 asection *asec;
1610 char *buffer = NULL;
1611 bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1612 unsigned i;
1613 unsigned long length;
1614 const char *error_message = NULL;
1615
1616 if (link_info == NULL)
1617 return;
1618
1619 apuinfo_list_init ();
1620
1621 /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1622 for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1623 {
1624 unsigned long datum;
1625
1626 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1627 if (asec == NULL)
1628 continue;
1629
1630 /* xgettext:c-format */
1631 error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1632 length = asec->size;
1633 if (length < 20)
1634 goto fail;
1635
1636 apuinfo_set = true;
1637 if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1638 {
1639 free (buffer);
1640 largest_input_size = asec->size;
1641 buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1642 if (!buffer)
1643 return;
1644 }
1645
1646 if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1647 || (bfd_read (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1648 {
1649 /* xgettext:c-format */
1650 error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1651 goto fail;
1652 }
1653
1654 /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1655 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1656 host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1657 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1658 if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1659 goto fail;
1660
1661 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1662 if (datum != 0x2)
1663 goto fail;
1664
1665 if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1666 goto fail;
1667
1668 /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1669 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1670 if (datum + 20 != length)
1671 goto fail;
1672
1673 /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1674 for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1675 apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1676 }
1677
1678 error_message = NULL;
1679
1680 if (apuinfo_set)
1681 {
1682 /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1683 unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1684
1685 /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1686 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1687
1688 if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1689 {
1690 ibfd = abfd;
1691 /* xgettext:c-format */
1692 error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1693 }
1694 }
1695
1696 fail:
1697 free (buffer);
1698
1699 if (error_message)
1700 _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1701 }
1702
1703 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1704 contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1705
1706 static bool
1707 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1708 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1709 asection *asec,
1710 bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1711 {
1712 return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1713 }
1714
1715 /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1716
1717 static void
1718 ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1719 {
1720 bfd_byte *buffer;
1721 asection *asec;
1722 unsigned i;
1723 unsigned num_entries;
1724 bfd_size_type length;
1725
1726 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1727 if (asec == NULL)
1728 return;
1729
1730 if (!apuinfo_set)
1731 return;
1732
1733 length = asec->size;
1734 if (length < 20)
1735 return;
1736
1737 buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1738 if (buffer == NULL)
1739 {
1740 _bfd_error_handler
1741 (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1742 return;
1743 }
1744
1745 /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1746 num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1747 bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1748 bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1749 bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1750 strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1751
1752 length = 20;
1753 for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1754 {
1755 bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1756 length += 4;
1757 }
1758
1759 if (length != asec->size)
1760 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1761
1762 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1763 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1764
1765 free (buffer);
1766
1767 apuinfo_list_finish ();
1768 }
1769
1770 static bool
1771 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1772 {
1773 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1774 return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1775 }
1776
1777 static bool
1779 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1780 {
1781 bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1782
1783 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1784 return false;
1785
1786 return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1787 && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1788 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1789 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1790 }
1791
1792 static bool
1793 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1794 {
1795 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1796 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1797 && section->vma <= vma
1798 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1799 }
1800
1801 static long
1802 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1803 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1804 asymbol **ret)
1805 {
1806 bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
1807 asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1808 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1809 bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1810 bfd_vma stub_off;
1811 asymbol *s;
1812 arelent *p;
1813 size_t count, i, stub_delta;
1814 size_t size;
1815 char *names;
1816 bfd_byte buf[4];
1817
1818 *ret = NULL;
1819
1820 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1821 return 0;
1822
1823 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1824 return 0;
1825
1826 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1827 if (relplt == NULL)
1828 return 0;
1829
1830 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1831 if (plt == NULL)
1832 return 0;
1833
1834 /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1835 if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1836 return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1837 dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1838
1839 /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1840 of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1841 dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1842 if (dynamic != NULL
1843 && (dynamic->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0)
1844 {
1845 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1846 size_t extdynsize;
1847 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1848
1849 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1850 return -1;
1851
1852 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1853 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1854
1855 for (extdyn = dynbuf, extdynend = dynbuf + dynamic->size;
1856 (size_t) (extdynend - extdyn) >= extdynsize;
1857 extdyn += extdynsize)
1858 {
1859 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1860 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1861
1862 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1863 break;
1864
1865 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1866 {
1867 unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1868 asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1869 if (got != NULL
1870 && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1871 g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1872 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1873 break;
1874 }
1875 }
1876 free (dynbuf);
1877 }
1878
1879 /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1880 if (glink_vma == 0)
1881 {
1882 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1883 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1884 }
1885
1886 if (glink_vma == 0)
1887 return 0;
1888
1889 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1890 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1891 glink stubs now reside. */
1892 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1893 if (glink == NULL)
1894 return 0;
1895
1896 /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1897 from the first glink stub. */
1898 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1899 glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1900 {
1901 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1902
1903 /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1904 insn ^= B;
1905 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1906 resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1907
1908 /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1909 else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1910 for (i = 4;
1911 bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1912 glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1913 i += 4)
1914 if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1915 {
1916 resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1917 break;
1918 }
1919 }
1920
1921 count = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr);
1922 /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1923 multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1924 there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1925 of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1926 The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1927 GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1928 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1929 for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1930 if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1931 break;
1932 if (stub_delta > 32)
1933 return 0;
1934
1935 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1936 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, true))
1937 return -1;
1938
1939 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1940 p = relplt->relocation;
1941 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1942 {
1943 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1944 if (p->addend != 0)
1945 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1946 }
1947
1948 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1949
1950 if (resolv_vma)
1951 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1952
1953 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1954 if (s == NULL)
1955 return -1;
1956
1957 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1958 names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1959 p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1960 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1961 {
1962 size_t len;
1963
1964 stub_off -= stub_delta;
1965 if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1966 stub_off -= 32;
1967 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1968 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1969 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1970 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1971 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1972 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1973 s->section = glink;
1974 s->value = stub_off;
1975 s->name = names;
1976 s->udata.p = NULL;
1977 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1978 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1979 names += len;
1980 if (p->addend != 0)
1981 {
1982 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1983 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1984 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1985 names += strlen (names);
1986 }
1987 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1988 names += sizeof ("@plt");
1989 ++s;
1990 --p;
1991 }
1992
1993 /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1994 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1995 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1996 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1997 s->section = glink;
1998 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1999 s->name = names;
2000 memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
2001 names += sizeof ("__glink");
2002 s++;
2003 count++;
2004
2005 if (resolv_vma)
2006 {
2007 /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
2008 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2009 s->the_bfd = abfd;
2010 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2011 s->section = glink;
2012 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2013 s->name = names;
2014 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2015 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2016 s++;
2017 count++;
2018 }
2019
2020 return count;
2021 }
2022
2023 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2025 functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2026 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2027 ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2028 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2029 called. */
2030
2031 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2032 than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2033 struct plt_entry
2034 {
2035 struct plt_entry *next;
2036
2037 /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2038 This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2039 GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2040 gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2041 sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2042 bfd_vma addend;
2043
2044 /* The .got2 section. */
2045 asection *sec;
2046
2047 /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2048 union
2049 {
2050 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2051 bfd_vma offset;
2052 } plt;
2053
2054 /* .glink stub offset. */
2055 bfd_vma glink_offset;
2056 };
2057
2058 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2059 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2060 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2061
2062 static int
2063 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2064 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2065 {
2066 switch (r_type)
2067 {
2068 default:
2069 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2070 address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2071 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2072 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2073 return 1;
2074
2075 case R_PPC_REL24:
2076 case R_PPC_REL14:
2077 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2078 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2079 case R_PPC_REL32:
2080 return 0;
2081
2082 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2083 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2084 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2085 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2086 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2087 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2088 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2089 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2090 }
2091 }
2092
2093 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2094 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2095 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2096 shared lib. */
2097 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2098
2099 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2100 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2101 {
2102 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2103
2104 /* The input section of the reloc. */
2105 asection *sec;
2106
2107 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2108 unsigned int count : 31;
2109
2110 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2111 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2112 };
2113
2114 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2115
2116 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2117 {
2118 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2119
2120 /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2121 specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2122 from the beginning of the section. */
2123 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2124
2125 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2126 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2127 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2128 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2129 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2130 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2131 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2132 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2133 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2134 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2135 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2136 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2137 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2138 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2139 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2140 unsigned char tls_mask;
2141
2142 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2143 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2144 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2145 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2146 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2147
2148 /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2149 symbol. */
2150 unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2151
2152 /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2153 unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2154 unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2155 };
2156
2157 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2158
2159 /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2160
2161 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2162 {
2163 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2164
2165 /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2166 struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2167
2168 /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2169 asection *glink;
2170 asection *dynsbss;
2171 asection *relsbss;
2172 elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2173 asection *sbss;
2174 asection *glink_eh_frame;
2175 asection *pltlocal;
2176 asection *relpltlocal;
2177
2178 /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2179 asection *srelplt2;
2180
2181 /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2182 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2183
2184 /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2185 bfd *old_bfd;
2186
2187 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2188 union {
2189 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2190 bfd_vma offset;
2191 } tlsld_got;
2192
2193 /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2194 bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2195
2196 /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2197 unsigned int got_header_size;
2198 /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2199 unsigned int got_gap;
2200
2201 /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2202 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2203
2204 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2205 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2206 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2207 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2208
2209 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2210 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2211
2212 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2213 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2214
2215 /* The size of PLT entries. */
2216 int plt_entry_size;
2217 /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2218 int plt_slot_size;
2219 /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2220 int plt_initial_entry_size;
2221 };
2222
2223 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2224 are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2225
2226 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2227 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2228
2229 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
2230 relocs. */
2231 #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
2232
2233 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2234 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2235
2236 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2237
2238 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2239 ((is_elf_hash_table ((p)->hash) \
2240 && elf_hash_table_id (elf_hash_table (p)) == PPC32_ELF_DATA) \
2241 ? (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) (p)->hash : NULL)
2242
2243 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2244
2245 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2246 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2247 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2248 const char *string)
2249 {
2250 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2251 subclass. */
2252 if (entry == NULL)
2253 {
2254 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2255 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2256 if (entry == NULL)
2257 return entry;
2258 }
2259
2260 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2261 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2262 if (entry != NULL)
2263 {
2264 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2265 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2266 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2267 }
2268
2269 return entry;
2270 }
2271
2272 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2273
2274 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2275 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2276 {
2277 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2278 static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2279 = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2280
2281 ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2282 if (ret == NULL)
2283 return NULL;
2284
2285 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2286 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2287 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry)))
2288 {
2289 free (ret);
2290 return NULL;
2291 }
2292
2293 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2294 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2295 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2296 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2297
2298 ret->params = &default_params;
2299
2300 ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2301 ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2302 ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2303
2304 ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2305 ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2306 ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2307
2308 ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2309 ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2310 ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2311
2312 return &ret->elf.root;
2313 }
2314
2315 /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2316
2317 void
2318 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2319 {
2320 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2321
2322 if (htab)
2323 htab->params = params;
2324 params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2325 }
2326
2327 /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2328
2329 static bool
2330 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2331 {
2332 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2333
2334 if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2335 return false;
2336
2337 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2338 if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2339 {
2340 /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2341 executable. */
2342 flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2343 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2344 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2345 return false;
2346 }
2347
2348 return true;
2349 }
2350
2351 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2352 R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2353 and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2354
2355 static bool
2356 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2357 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2358 flagword flags,
2359 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2360 {
2361 asection *s;
2362
2363 flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2364 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2365
2366 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2367 if (s == NULL)
2368 return false;
2369 lsect->section = s;
2370
2371 /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2372 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2373
2374 lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2375 if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2376 return false;
2377 lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2378 return true;
2379 }
2380
2381 static bool
2382 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2383 {
2384 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2385 asection *s;
2386 flagword flags;
2387 int p2align;
2388
2389 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2390 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2391 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2392 htab->glink = s;
2393 p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2394 if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2395 p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2396 if (s == NULL
2397 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
2398 return false;
2399
2400 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2401 {
2402 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2403 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2404 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2405 htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2406 if (s == NULL
2407 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2408 return false;
2409 }
2410
2411 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2412 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2413 htab->elf.iplt = s;
2414 if (s == NULL
2415 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
2416 return false;
2417
2418 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2419 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2420 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2421 htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2422 if (s == NULL
2423 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2424 return false;
2425
2426 /* Local plt entries. */
2427 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2428 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2429 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2430 flags);
2431 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2432 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
2433 return false;
2434
2435 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2436 {
2437 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2438 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2439 htab->relpltlocal
2440 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2441 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2442 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2443 return false;
2444 }
2445
2446 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2447 &htab->sdata[0]))
2448 return false;
2449
2450 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2451 &htab->sdata[1]))
2452 return false;
2453
2454 return true;
2455 }
2456
2457 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2458 to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2459 to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2460
2461 static bool
2462 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2463 {
2464 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2465 asection *s;
2466 flagword flags;
2467
2468 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2469
2470 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2471 && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2472 return false;
2473
2474 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2475 return false;
2476
2477 if (htab->glink == NULL
2478 && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2479 return false;
2480
2481 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2482 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2483 htab->dynsbss = s;
2484 if (s == NULL)
2485 return false;
2486
2487 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2488 {
2489 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2490 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2491 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2492 htab->relsbss = s;
2493 if (s == NULL
2494 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2495 return false;
2496 }
2497
2498 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
2499 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2500 return false;
2501
2502 s = htab->elf.splt;
2503 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2504 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2505 /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2506 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2507 return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
2508 }
2509
2510 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2511
2512 static void
2513 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2514 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2515 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2516 {
2517 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2518
2519 edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2520 eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2521
2522 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2523 edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2524
2525 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2526 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2527 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2528 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2529 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2530 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2531 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2532
2533 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2534 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2535 return;
2536
2537 if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2538 {
2539 if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2540 {
2541 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2542 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2543
2544 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2545 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2546 for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2547 {
2548 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2549
2550 for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2551 if (q->sec == p->sec)
2552 {
2553 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2554 q->count += p->count;
2555 *pp = p->next;
2556 break;
2557 }
2558 if (q == NULL)
2559 pp = &p->next;
2560 }
2561 *pp = dir->dyn_relocs;
2562 }
2563
2564 dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs;
2565 ind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2566 }
2567
2568 /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2569 the symbol which just became indirect. */
2570 edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2571 eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2572
2573 /* And plt entries. */
2574 if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2575 {
2576 if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2577 {
2578 struct plt_entry **entp;
2579 struct plt_entry *ent;
2580
2581 for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2582 {
2583 struct plt_entry *dent;
2584
2585 for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2586 if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2587 {
2588 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2589 *entp = ent->next;
2590 break;
2591 }
2592 if (dent == NULL)
2593 entp = &ent->next;
2594 }
2595 *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2596 }
2597
2598 edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2599 eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2600 }
2601
2602 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2603 {
2604 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2605 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2606 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2607 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2608 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2609 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2610 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2611 }
2612 }
2613
2614 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2615 file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2616
2617 static bool
2618 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2619 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2620 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2621 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2622 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2623 asection **secp,
2624 bfd_vma *valp)
2625 {
2626 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2627 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2628 && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2629 && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2630 {
2631 /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2632 put into .sbss. */
2633 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2634
2635 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2636 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2637 {
2638 flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2639
2640 if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2641 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2642
2643 htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2644 ".sbss",
2645 flags);
2646 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2647 return false;
2648 }
2649
2650 *secp = htab->sbss;
2651 *valp = sym->st_size;
2652 }
2653
2654 return true;
2655 }
2656
2657 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2659
2660 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2661 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2662 (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2663 bfd_vma addend,
2664 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2665 {
2666 for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2667 if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2668 return linker_pointers;
2669
2670 return NULL;
2671 }
2672
2673 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2674
2675 static bool
2676 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2677 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2678 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2679 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2680 {
2681 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2682 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2683 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2684 bfd_size_type amt;
2685
2686 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2687
2688 /* Is this a global symbol? */
2689 if (h != NULL)
2690 {
2691 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2692
2693 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2694 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2695 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2696 rel->r_addend,
2697 lsect))
2698 return true;
2699
2700 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2701 }
2702 else
2703 {
2704 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2705
2706 /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2707 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2708
2709 /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2710 if (!ptr)
2711 {
2712 unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2713
2714 amt = num_symbols;
2715 amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2716 ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2717
2718 if (!ptr)
2719 return false;
2720
2721 elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2722 }
2723
2724 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2725 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2726 rel->r_addend,
2727 lsect))
2728 return true;
2729
2730 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2731 }
2732
2733 /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2734 a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2735 BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2736 amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2737 linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2738
2739 if (!linker_section_ptr)
2740 return false;
2741
2742 linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2743 linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2744 linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2745 *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2746
2747 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
2748 return false;
2749 linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2750 lsect->section->size += 4;
2751
2752 #ifdef DEBUG
2753 fprintf (stderr,
2754 "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2755 lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2756 (long) lsect->section->size);
2757 #endif
2758
2759 return true;
2760 }
2761
2762 static struct plt_entry **
2763 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2764 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2765 unsigned long r_symndx,
2766 int tls_type)
2767 {
2768 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2769 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2770 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2771
2772 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2773 {
2774 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2775
2776 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2777 + sizeof (*local_plt)
2778 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2779 local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2780 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2781 return NULL;
2782 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2783 }
2784
2785 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2786 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2787 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2788 if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2789 local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2790 return local_plt + r_symndx;
2791 }
2792
2793 static bool
2794 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2795 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2796 {
2797 struct plt_entry *ent;
2798
2799 if (addend < 32768)
2800 sec = NULL;
2801 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2802 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2803 break;
2804 if (ent == NULL)
2805 {
2806 size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
2807 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2808 if (ent == NULL)
2809 return false;
2810 ent->next = *plist;
2811 ent->sec = sec;
2812 ent->addend = addend;
2813 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2814 *plist = ent;
2815 }
2816 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2817 return true;
2818 }
2819
2820 static struct plt_entry *
2821 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2822 {
2823 struct plt_entry *ent;
2824
2825 if (addend < 32768)
2826 sec = NULL;
2827 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2828 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2829 break;
2830 return ent;
2831 }
2832
2833 static bool
2834 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2835 {
2836 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2837 || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2838 || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2839 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2840 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2841 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2842 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2843 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2844 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2845 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2846 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2847 }
2848
2849 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2850
2851 static bool
2852 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2853 {
2854 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2855 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2856 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2857 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2858 }
2859
2860 /* Like bfd_reloc_offset_in_range but without a howto. Return true
2861 iff a field of SIZE bytes at OFFSET is within SEC limits. */
2862
2863 static bool
2864 offset_in_range (asection *sec, bfd_vma offset, size_t size)
2865 {
2866 return offset <= sec->size && size <= sec->size - offset;
2867 }
2868
2869 static void
2870 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2871 {
2872 _bfd_error_handler
2873 /* xgettext:c-format */
2874 (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2875 abfd,
2876 ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2877 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2878 }
2879
2880 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2881 allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2882 table. */
2883
2884 static bool
2885 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2886 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2887 asection *sec,
2888 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2889 {
2890 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2891 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2892 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2893 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2894 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2895 asection *got2, *sreloc;
2896 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2897
2898 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2899 return true;
2900
2901 #ifdef DEBUG
2902 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2903 sec, abfd);
2904 #endif
2905
2906 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2907
2908 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2909 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2910 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2911
2912 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2913 if (htab->glink == NULL)
2914 {
2915 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2916 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2917 if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2918 return false;
2919 }
2920 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2921 false, false, true);
2922 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2923 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2924 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2925 sreloc = NULL;
2926
2927 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2928 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2929 {
2930 unsigned long r_symndx;
2931 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2932 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2933 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
2934 int tls_type;
2935 struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2936 struct plt_entry **pltent;
2937 bfd_vma addend;
2938
2939 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2940 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2941 {
2942 h = NULL;
2943 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache, abfd, r_symndx);
2944 if (isym == NULL)
2945 return false;
2946 }
2947 else
2948 {
2949 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2950 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2951 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2952 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2953 isym = NULL;
2954 }
2955
2956 /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2957 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2958 startup code. */
2959 if (h != NULL
2960 && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2961 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2962 {
2963 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2964 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2965 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2966 return false;
2967 BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2968 }
2969
2970 tls_type = 0;
2971 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2972 ifunc = NULL;
2973 if (h != NULL)
2974 {
2975 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2976 {
2977 h->needs_plt = 1;
2978 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
2979 }
2980 }
2981 else if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2982 {
2983 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2984 {
2985 /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2986 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2987 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2988 if (ifunc == NULL)
2989 return false;
2990
2991 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2992 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2993 no plt calls. */
2994 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2995 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2996 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2997 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2998 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2999 {
3000 addend = 0;
3001 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3002 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3003 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3004 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3005 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3006 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3007 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3008 addend = rel->r_addend;
3009 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
3010 return false;
3011 }
3012 }
3013 }
3014
3015 if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
3016 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3017 && h != NULL
3018 && h == tga)
3019 {
3020 if (rel != relocs
3021 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3022 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3023 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3024 reloc. */
3025 ;
3026 else
3027 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3028 sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
3029 }
3030
3031 switch (r_type)
3032 {
3033 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3034 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3035 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3036 its parameter symbol. */
3037 if (h != NULL)
3038 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3039 else
3040 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3041 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3042 return false;
3043 break;
3044
3045 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3046 break;
3047
3048 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3049 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3050 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3051 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3052 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3053 goto dogottls;
3054
3055 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3056 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3057 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3058 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3059 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3060 goto dogottls;
3061
3062 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3063 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3064 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3065 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3066 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3067 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3068 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3069 goto dogottls;
3070
3071 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3072 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3073 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3074 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3075 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3076 dogottls:
3077 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3078 /* Fall through. */
3079
3080 /* GOT16 relocations */
3081 case R_PPC_GOT16:
3082 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3083 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3084 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3085 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3086 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3087 {
3088 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3089 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3090 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3091 return false;
3092 }
3093 if (h != NULL)
3094 {
3095 h->got.refcount += 1;
3096 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3097 }
3098 else
3099 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3100 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3101 return false;
3102
3103 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3104 an ifunc. */
3105 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3106 {
3107 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3108 return false;
3109 }
3110 break;
3111
3112 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3113 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3114 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3115 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3116 h, rel))
3117 return false;
3118 if (h != NULL)
3119 {
3120 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3121 h->non_got_ref = true;
3122 }
3123 break;
3124
3125 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3126 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3127 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3128 {
3129 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3130 return false;
3131 }
3132 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3133 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3134 h, rel))
3135 return false;
3136 if (h != NULL)
3137 {
3138 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3139 h->non_got_ref = true;
3140 }
3141 break;
3142
3143 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3144 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3145 /* Fall through. */
3146
3147 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3148 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3149 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3150 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3151 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3152 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3153 if (h != NULL)
3154 {
3155 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3156 h->non_got_ref = true;
3157 }
3158 break;
3159
3160 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3161 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3162 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3163 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3164 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3165 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3166 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3167 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3168 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3169 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3170 break;
3171
3172 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3173 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3174 {
3175 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3176 return false;
3177 }
3178 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3179 if (h != NULL)
3180 {
3181 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3182 h->non_got_ref = true;
3183 }
3184 break;
3185
3186 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3187 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3188 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3189 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3190 if (h != NULL)
3191 {
3192 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
3193 h->non_got_ref = true;
3194 }
3195 break;
3196
3197 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3198 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3199 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3200 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3201 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3202 if (h != NULL)
3203 h->non_got_ref = true;
3204 break;
3205
3206 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3207 if (h == NULL)
3208 break;
3209 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3210 goto pltentry;
3211
3212 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3213 sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3214 /* Fall through. */
3215
3216 case R_PPC_PLT32:
3217 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3218 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3219 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3220 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3221 pltentry:
3222 #ifdef DEBUG
3223 fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3224 #endif
3225 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3226 if (h == NULL)
3227 {
3228 pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3229 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3230 if (pltent == NULL)
3231 return false;
3232 }
3233 else
3234 {
3235 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3236 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3237 h->needs_plt = 1;
3238 pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3239 }
3240 addend = 0;
3241 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3242 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3243 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3244 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3245 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3246 addend = rel->r_addend;
3247 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3248 return false;
3249 break;
3250
3251 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3252 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3253 section relative. */
3254 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3255 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3256 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3257 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3258 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3259 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3260 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3261 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3262 case R_PPC_TOC16:
3263 break;
3264
3265 case R_PPC_REL16:
3266 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3267 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3268 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3269 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3270 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3271 break;
3272
3273 /* These are just markers. */
3274 case R_PPC_TLS:
3275 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3276 case R_PPC_NONE:
3277 case R_PPC_max:
3278 case R_PPC_RELAX:
3279 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3280 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3281 case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3282 break;
3283
3284 /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3285 case R_PPC_COPY:
3286 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3287 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3288 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3289 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3290 break;
3291
3292 /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3293 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3294 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3295 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3296 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3297 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3298 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3299 break;
3300
3301 /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3302 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3303 if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3304 {
3305 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3306 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3307 }
3308 if (h != NULL
3309 && ifunc != NULL
3310 && !update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, NULL, 0))
3311 return false;
3312 break;
3313
3314 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3315 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3316 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3317 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3318 return false;
3319 break;
3320
3321 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3322 used. Record for later use during GC. */
3323 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3324 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3325 return false;
3326 break;
3327
3328 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3329 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3330 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3331 /* Fall through. */
3332 /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3333 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3334 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3335 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3336 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3337 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3338 goto dodyn;
3339
3340 /* Nor these. */
3341 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3342 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3343 goto dodyn;
3344
3345 case R_PPC_REL32:
3346 if (h == NULL
3347 && got2 != NULL
3348 && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3349 && bfd_link_pic (info)
3350 && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3351 {
3352 /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3353 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3354 reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3355 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3356 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3357 PLT call stubs. */
3358 asection *s;
3359
3360 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3361 if (s == got2)
3362 {
3363 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3364 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3365 }
3366 }
3367 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3368 break;
3369 /* fall through */
3370
3371 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3372 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3373 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3374 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3375 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3376 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3377 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3378 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3379 {
3380 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3381 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3382 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3383 return false;
3384
3385 /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3386 h->non_got_ref = 1;
3387 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3388 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3389 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3390 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3391 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3392 }
3393 goto dodyn;
3394
3395 case R_PPC_REL24:
3396 case R_PPC_REL14:
3397 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3398 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3399 if (h == NULL)
3400 break;
3401 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3402 {
3403 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3404 {
3405 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3406 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3407 }
3408 break;
3409 }
3410 /* fall through */
3411
3412 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3413 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3414 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3415 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3416 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3417 {
3418 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3419 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3420 h->needs_plt = 1;
3421 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3422 return false;
3423 break;
3424 }
3425
3426 dodyn:
3427 /* Set up information for symbols that might need dynamic
3428 relocations. At this point in linking we have read all
3429 the input files and resolved most symbols, but have not
3430 yet decided whether symbols are dynamic or finalized
3431 symbol flags. In some cases we might be setting dynamic
3432 reloc info for symbols that do not end up needing such.
3433 That's OK, adjust_dynamic_symbol and allocate_dynrelocs
3434 work together with this code. */
3435 if ((h != NULL
3436 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
3437 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
3438 && (h != NULL
3439 ? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
3440 : isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
3441 && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
3442 {
3443 #ifdef DEBUG
3444 fprintf (stderr,
3445 "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3446 "create relocation for %s\n",
3447 (h && h->root.root.string
3448 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3449 #endif
3450 if (sreloc == NULL)
3451 {
3452 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3453 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3454
3455 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3456 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ true);
3457
3458 if (sreloc == NULL)
3459 return false;
3460 }
3461
3462 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3463 relocations we need for this symbol. */
3464 if (h != NULL)
3465 {
3466 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3467 struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3468
3469 rel_head = &h->dyn_relocs;
3470 p = *rel_head;
3471 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3472 {
3473 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3474 if (p == NULL)
3475 return false;
3476 p->next = *rel_head;
3477 *rel_head = p;
3478 p->sec = sec;
3479 p->count = 0;
3480 p->pc_count = 0;
3481 }
3482 p->count += 1;
3483 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3484 p->pc_count += 1;
3485 }
3486 else
3487 {
3488 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3489 We really need local syms available to do this
3490 easily. Oh well. */
3491 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3492 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3493 bool is_ifunc;
3494 asection *s;
3495 void *vpp;
3496
3497 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3498 if (s == NULL)
3499 s = sec;
3500
3501 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3502 rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3503 is_ifunc = ifunc != NULL;
3504 p = *rel_head;
3505 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3506 p = p->next;
3507 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3508 {
3509 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3510 if (p == NULL)
3511 return false;
3512 p->next = *rel_head;
3513 *rel_head = p;
3514 p->sec = sec;
3515 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3516 p->count = 0;
3517 }
3518 p->count += 1;
3519 }
3520 }
3521
3522 break;
3523 }
3524 }
3525
3526 return true;
3527 }
3528
3529 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3531 and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3532 bool
3533 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3534 {
3535 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3536 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3537 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3538 bool ret = true;
3539 bool warn_only;
3540
3541 /* We only warn about shared library mismatches, because common
3542 libraries advertise support for a particular long double variant
3543 but actually support more than one variant. For example, glibc
3544 typically supports 128-bit IBM long double in the shared library
3545 but has a compatibility static archive for 64-bit long double.
3546 The linker doesn't have the smarts to see that an app using
3547 object files marked as 64-bit long double call the compatibility
3548 layer objects and only from there call into the shared library. */
3549 warn_only = (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0;
3550
3551 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3552 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3553
3554 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3555 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3556
3557 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3558 {
3559 int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3560 int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3561 static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3562
3563 if (in_fp == 0)
3564 ;
3565 else if (out_fp == 0)
3566 {
3567 if (!warn_only)
3568 {
3569 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3570 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3571 last_fp = ibfd;
3572 }
3573 }
3574 else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3575 {
3576 _bfd_error_handler
3577 /* xgettext:c-format */
3578 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3579 last_fp, ibfd);
3580 ret = warn_only;
3581 }
3582 else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3583 {
3584 _bfd_error_handler
3585 /* xgettext:c-format */
3586 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3587 ibfd, last_fp);
3588 ret = warn_only;
3589 }
3590 else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3591 {
3592 _bfd_error_handler
3593 /* xgettext:c-format */
3594 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3595 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3596 ret = warn_only;
3597 }
3598 else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3599 {
3600 _bfd_error_handler
3601 /* xgettext:c-format */
3602 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3603 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3604 ret = warn_only;
3605 }
3606
3607 in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3608 out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3609 if (in_fp == 0)
3610 ;
3611 else if (out_fp == 0)
3612 {
3613 if (!warn_only)
3614 {
3615 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3616 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3617 last_ld = ibfd;
3618 }
3619 }
3620 else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3621 {
3622 _bfd_error_handler
3623 /* xgettext:c-format */
3624 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3625 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3626 ret = warn_only;
3627 }
3628 else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3629 {
3630 _bfd_error_handler
3631 /* xgettext:c-format */
3632 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3633 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3634 ret = warn_only;
3635 }
3636 else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3637 {
3638 _bfd_error_handler
3639 /* xgettext:c-format */
3640 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3641 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3642 ret = warn_only;
3643 }
3644 else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3645 {
3646 _bfd_error_handler
3647 /* xgettext:c-format */
3648 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3649 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3650 ret = warn_only;
3651 }
3652 }
3653
3654 if (!ret)
3655 {
3656 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3657 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3658 }
3659 return ret;
3660 }
3661
3662 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3663 there are conflicting attributes. */
3664 static bool
3665 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3666 {
3667 bfd *obfd;
3668 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3669 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3670 bool ret;
3671
3672 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3673 return false;
3674
3675 obfd = info->output_bfd;
3676 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3677 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3678
3679 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3680 merge non-conflicting ones. */
3681 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3682 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3683 ret = true;
3684 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3685 {
3686 int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3687 int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3688 static bfd *last_vec;
3689
3690 if (in_vec == 0)
3691 ;
3692 else if (out_vec == 0)
3693 {
3694 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3695 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3696 last_vec = ibfd;
3697 }
3698 /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3699 without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3700 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3701 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3702 case too. */
3703 else if (in_vec == 1)
3704 ;
3705 else if (out_vec == 1)
3706 {
3707 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3708 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3709 last_vec = ibfd;
3710 }
3711 else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3712 {
3713 _bfd_error_handler
3714 /* xgettext:c-format */
3715 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3716 last_vec, ibfd);
3717 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3718 ret = false;
3719 }
3720 else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3721 {
3722 _bfd_error_handler
3723 /* xgettext:c-format */
3724 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3725 ibfd, last_vec);
3726 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3727 ret = false;
3728 }
3729 }
3730
3731 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3732 and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3733 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3734 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3735 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3736 {
3737 int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3738 int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3739 static bfd *last_struct;
3740
3741 if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3742 ;
3743 else if (out_struct == 0)
3744 {
3745 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3746 out_attr->i = in_struct;
3747 last_struct = ibfd;
3748 }
3749 else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3750 {
3751 _bfd_error_handler
3752 /* xgettext:c-format */
3753 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3754 "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3755 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3756 ret = false;
3757 }
3758 else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3759 {
3760 _bfd_error_handler
3761 /* xgettext:c-format */
3762 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3763 "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3764 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3765 ret = false;
3766 }
3767 }
3768 if (!ret)
3769 {
3770 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3771 return false;
3772 }
3773
3774 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3775 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3776 }
3777
3778 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3779 object file when linking. */
3780
3781 static bool
3782 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3783 {
3784 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3785 flagword old_flags;
3786 flagword new_flags;
3787 bool error;
3788
3789 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3790 return true;
3791
3792 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3793 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3794 return false;
3795
3796 if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3797 return false;
3798
3799 if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
3800 return true;
3801
3802 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3803 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3804 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3805 {
3806 /* First call, no flags set. */
3807 elf_flags_init (obfd) = true;
3808 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3809 }
3810
3811 /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3812 else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3813 ;
3814
3815 /* Incompatible flags. */
3816 else
3817 {
3818 /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3819 to be linked with either. */
3820 error = false;
3821 if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3822 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3823 {
3824 error = true;
3825 _bfd_error_handler
3826 (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3827 "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3828 }
3829 else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3830 && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3831 {
3832 error = true;
3833 _bfd_error_handler
3834 (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3835 "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3836 }
3837
3838 /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3839 if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3840 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3841
3842 /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3843 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3844 if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3845 && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3846 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3847 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3848
3849 /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3850 any module uses it. */
3851 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3852
3853 new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3854 old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3855
3856 /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3857 if (new_flags != old_flags)
3858 {
3859 error = true;
3860 _bfd_error_handler
3861 /* xgettext:c-format */
3862 (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3863 "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3864 ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3865 }
3866
3867 if (error)
3868 {
3869 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3870 return false;
3871 }
3872 }
3873
3874 return true;
3875 }
3876
3877 static bfd_reloc_status_type
3878 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3879 asection *input_section,
3880 unsigned long offset,
3881 bfd_byte *loc,
3882 bfd_vma value,
3883 split16_format_type split16_format,
3884 bool fixup)
3885 {
3886 unsigned int insn, opcode;
3887
3888 if (!offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
3889 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
3890 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3891 opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3892 if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3893 || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3894 || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3895 || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3896 || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3897 {
3898 if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3899 {
3900 if (fixup)
3901 split16_format = split16a_type;
3902 else
3903 _bfd_error_handler
3904 /* xgettext:c-format */
3905 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3906 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3907 }
3908 }
3909 else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3910 || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3911 || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3912 || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3913 || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3914 || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3915 || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3916 {
3917 if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3918 {
3919 if (fixup)
3920 split16_format = split16d_type;
3921 else
3922 _bfd_error_handler
3923 /* xgettext:c-format */
3924 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3925 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3926 }
3927 }
3928 if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3929 {
3930 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3931 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3932 if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3933 {
3934 /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3935 insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3936 insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3937 }
3938 }
3939 else
3940 {
3941 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3942 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3943 }
3944 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3945 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3946 return bfd_reloc_ok;
3947 }
3948
3949 static void
3950 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3951 {
3952 unsigned int insn;
3953
3954 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3955 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3956 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3957 insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3958 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3959 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3960 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3961 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3962 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3963 }
3964
3965
3966 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3968 Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3969 int
3970 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3971 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3972 {
3973 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3974 flagword flags;
3975
3976 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3977
3978 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3979 {
3980 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3981
3982 if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3983 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3984 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3985 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3986 && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3987 false, false, true)) != NULL
3988 && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3989 || h->needs_plt)
3990 && h->ref_regular
3991 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3992 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3993 {
3994 /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3995 secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3996 function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3997 r30 to be set up. */
3998 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3999 }
4000 else
4001 {
4002 bfd *ibfd;
4003 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
4004
4005 /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
4006 Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4007 without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4008 --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
4009 if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4010 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4011 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4012 if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4013 {
4014 if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4015 plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4016 else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4017 {
4018 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4019 htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4020 break;
4021 }
4022 }
4023 htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4024 }
4025 }
4026 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
4027 {
4028 if (!info->user_warn_rwx_segments)
4029 info->no_warn_rwx_segments = 1;
4030 if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW
4031 || (htab->params->plt_style != PLT_OLD
4032 && !info->no_warn_rwx_segments))
4033 {
4034 if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4035 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4036 else
4037 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4038 }
4039 }
4040
4041 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4042
4043 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4044 {
4045 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4046 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4047
4048 /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4049 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4050 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
4051 return -1;
4052
4053 /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4054 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4055 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4056 return -1;
4057 }
4058 else
4059 {
4060 /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4061 if (htab->glink != NULL
4062 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
4063 return -1;
4064 }
4065 return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4066 }
4067
4068 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4070 relocation. */
4071
4072 static asection *
4073 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4074 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4075 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4076 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4077 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4078 {
4079 if (h != NULL)
4080 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4081 {
4082 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4083 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4084 return NULL;
4085 }
4086
4087 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4088 }
4089
4090 static bool
4091 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4092 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4093 asection **symsecp,
4094 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4095 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4096 unsigned long r_symndx,
4097 bfd *ibfd)
4098 {
4099 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4100
4101 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4102 {
4103 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4104 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4105
4106 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4107 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4108 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4109 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4110
4111 if (hp != NULL)
4112 *hp = h;
4113
4114 if (symp != NULL)
4115 *symp = NULL;
4116
4117 if (symsecp != NULL)
4118 {
4119 asection *symsec = NULL;
4120 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4121 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4122 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4123 *symsecp = symsec;
4124 }
4125
4126 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4127 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4128 }
4129 else
4130 {
4131 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4132 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4133
4134 if (locsyms == NULL)
4135 {
4136 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4137 if (locsyms == NULL)
4138 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4139 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4140 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4141 if (locsyms == NULL)
4142 return false;
4143 *locsymsp = locsyms;
4144 }
4145 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4146
4147 if (hp != NULL)
4148 *hp = NULL;
4149
4150 if (symp != NULL)
4151 *symp = sym;
4152
4153 if (symsecp != NULL)
4154 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4155
4156 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4157 {
4158 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4159 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4160
4161 tls_mask = NULL;
4162 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4163 if (local_got != NULL)
4164 {
4165 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4166 (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4167 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4168 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4169 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4170 }
4171 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4172 }
4173 }
4174 return true;
4175 }
4176
4177 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4179 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4180
4181 bool
4182 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4183 {
4184 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4185 bfd *ibfd;
4186 asection *sec;
4187 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4188
4189 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4190 if (htab == NULL)
4191 return false;
4192
4193 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4194 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4195 between the call and its destination. */
4196 limit = 0x1e00000;
4197 low_vma = -1;
4198 high_vma = 0;
4199 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4200 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4201 {
4202 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4203 low_vma = sec->vma;
4204 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4205 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4206 }
4207
4208 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4209 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4210 is local. */
4211 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4212 {
4213 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4214 return true;
4215 }
4216
4217 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4218 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4219 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4220 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4221 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4222 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4223 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4224 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4225 particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4226 call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4227 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4228 together except their symbol. */
4229
4230 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4231 {
4232 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4233 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4234
4235 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4236 continue;
4237
4238 local_syms = NULL;
4239 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4240
4241 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4242 if (sec->has_pltcall
4243 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4244 {
4245 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4246
4247 /* Read the relocations. */
4248 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4249 info->keep_memory);
4250 if (relstart == NULL)
4251 return false;
4252
4253 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4254 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4255 {
4256 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4257 unsigned long r_symndx;
4258 asection *sym_sec;
4259 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4260 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4261 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4262
4263 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4264 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4265 continue;
4266
4267 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4268 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4269 r_symndx, ibfd))
4270 {
4271 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4272 free (relstart);
4273 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4274 free (local_syms);
4275 return false;
4276 }
4277
4278 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4279 {
4280 bfd_vma from, to;
4281 if (h != NULL)
4282 to = h->root.u.def.value;
4283 else
4284 to = sym->st_value;
4285 to += (rel->r_addend
4286 + sym_sec->output_offset
4287 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4288 from = (rel->r_offset
4289 + sec->output_offset
4290 + sec->output_section->vma);
4291 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4292 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4293 }
4294 }
4295 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4296 free (relstart);
4297 }
4298
4299 if (local_syms != NULL
4300 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4301 {
4302 if (!info->keep_memory)
4303 free (local_syms);
4304 else
4305 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4306 }
4307 }
4308
4309 return true;
4310 }
4311
4312 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4313 generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4314
4315 asection *
4316 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4317 {
4318 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4319
4320 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4321 htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4322 false, false, true);
4323 if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4324 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
4325
4326 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4327 {
4328 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4329 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4330 false, false, true);
4331 if (opt != NULL
4332 && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4333 || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4334 {
4335 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4336 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4337 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4338 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4339 tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4340 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4341 && tga != NULL
4342 && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4343 || tga->needs_plt)
4344 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4345 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4346 {
4347 struct plt_entry *ent;
4348 for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4349 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4350 break;
4351 if (ent != NULL)
4352 {
4353 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4354 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4355 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4356 opt->mark = 1;
4357 if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4358 {
4359 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4360 opt->dynindx = -1;
4361 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4362 opt->dynstr_index);
4363 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4364 return NULL;
4365 }
4366 htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4367 }
4368 }
4369 }
4370 else
4371 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
4372 }
4373 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4374 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4375 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4376 {
4377 elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4378 elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4379 }
4380
4381 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4382 }
4383
4384 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4385 HASH. */
4386
4387 static bool
4388 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4389 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4390 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4391 {
4392 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4393 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4394 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4395
4396 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4397 {
4398 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4399 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4400
4401 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4402 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4403 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4404 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4405 if (h == hash)
4406 return true;
4407 }
4408 return false;
4409 }
4410
4411 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4412 opportunities. */
4413
4414 bool
4415 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4416 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4417 {
4418 bfd *ibfd;
4419 asection *sec;
4420 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4421 int pass;
4422
4423 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4424 return true;
4425
4426 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4427 if (htab == NULL)
4428 return false;
4429
4430 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4431
4432 /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4433 relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4434 followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4435 optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4436 notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4437 adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4438 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4439 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4440 {
4441 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4442 asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4443
4444 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4445 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4446 {
4447 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4448 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4449
4450 /* Read the relocations. */
4451 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4452 info->keep_memory);
4453 if (relstart == NULL)
4454 return false;
4455
4456 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4457 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4458 {
4459 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4460 unsigned long r_symndx;
4461 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4462 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4463 unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4464 bool is_local;
4465 bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4466
4467 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4468 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4469 {
4470 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4471
4472 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4473 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4474 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4475 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4476 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4477 }
4478
4479 is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
4480 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4481 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4482 without marker relocs, then check that each
4483 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4484 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4485 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4486 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4487 if (pass == 0
4488 && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4489 && h != NULL
4490 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4491 && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4492 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4493 {
4494 info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4495 "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4496 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4497 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4498 free (relstart);
4499 return true;
4500 }
4501
4502 expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4503 switch (r_type)
4504 {
4505 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4506 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4507 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4508 /* Fall through. */
4509
4510 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4511 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4512 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4513 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4514 that turns out to be the case. */
4515 if (!is_local)
4516 continue;
4517
4518 /* LD -> LE */
4519 tls_set = 0;
4520 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4521 break;
4522
4523 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4524 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4525 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4526 /* Fall through. */
4527
4528 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4529 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4530 if (is_local)
4531 /* GD -> LE */
4532 tls_set = 0;
4533 else
4534 /* GD -> IE */
4535 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4536 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4537 break;
4538
4539 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4540 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4541 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4542 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4543 if (is_local)
4544 {
4545 /* IE -> LE */
4546 tls_set = 0;
4547 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4548 break;
4549 }
4550 else
4551 continue;
4552
4553 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4554 if (!is_local)
4555 continue;
4556 /* Fall through. */
4557 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4558 if (rel + 1 < relend
4559 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4560 {
4561 if (pass != 0
4562 && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4563 {
4564 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4565 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4566 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4567 {
4568 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4569
4570 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4571 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4572 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4573 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4574 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4575 if (h != NULL)
4576 {
4577 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4578 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4579
4580 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4581 addend = rel->r_addend;
4582 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4583 got2, addend);
4584 if (ent != NULL
4585 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4586 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4587 }
4588 }
4589 }
4590 continue;
4591 }
4592 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4593 tls_set = 0;
4594 tls_clear = 0;
4595 break;
4596
4597 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
4598 if (pass == 0)
4599 {
4600 unsigned char buf[4];
4601 unsigned int insn;
4602 bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
4603 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
4604 off, 4))
4605 {
4606 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4607 free (relstart);
4608 return false;
4609 }
4610 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
4611 /* addis rt,2,imm */
4612 if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
4613 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)))
4614 {
4615 /* xgettext:c-format */
4616 info->callbacks->minfo
4617 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
4618 ibfd, sec, off, "R_PPC_TPREL16_HA", insn);
4619 htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
4620 }
4621 }
4622 continue;
4623
4624 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
4625 htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
4626 continue;
4627
4628 default:
4629 continue;
4630 }
4631
4632 if (pass == 0)
4633 {
4634 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4635 || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4636 continue;
4637
4638 if (rel + 1 < relend
4639 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4640 htab->tls_get_addr))
4641 continue;
4642
4643 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4644 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4645 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4646 the entire optimization. */
4647 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4648 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4649 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4650 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4651 free (relstart);
4652 return true;
4653 }
4654
4655 if (h != NULL)
4656 {
4657 tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4658 got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4659 }
4660 else
4661 {
4662 bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4663 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4664 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4665
4666 lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4667 if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4668 abort ();
4669 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4670 (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4671 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4672 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4673 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4674 got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4675 }
4676
4677 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4678 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4679 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4680 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4681 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4682 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4683 Disable optimization in this case. */
4684 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4685 && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4686 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4687 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4688 continue;
4689
4690 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4691 {
4692 struct plt_entry *ent;
4693 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4694
4695 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4696 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4697 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4698 addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4699 ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4700 got2, addend);
4701 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4702 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4703 }
4704 if (tls_clear == 0)
4705 continue;
4706
4707 if (tls_set == 0)
4708 {
4709 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4710 if (*got_count > 0)
4711 *got_count -= 1;
4712 }
4713
4714 *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4715 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4716 }
4717
4718 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4719 free (relstart);
4720 }
4721 }
4722 return true;
4723 }
4724
4725 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4727 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4728 size_dynamic_sections. */
4729
4730 static bool
4731 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4732 {
4733 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4734 do
4735 {
4736 if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4737 return true;
4738 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4739 } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4740
4741 return false;
4742 }
4743
4744 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4745
4746 static bool
4747 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4748 {
4749 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4750
4751 for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4752 if (p->pc_count != 0)
4753 return true;
4754 return false;
4755 }
4756
4757 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4758 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4759 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4760 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4761 understand. */
4762
4763 static bool
4764 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4765 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4766 {
4767 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4768 asection *s;
4769
4770 #ifdef DEBUG
4771 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4772 h->root.root.string);
4773 #endif
4774
4775 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4776 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4777 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4778 && (h->needs_plt
4779 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4780 || h->is_weakalias
4781 || (h->def_dynamic
4782 && h->ref_regular
4783 && !h->def_regular)));
4784
4785 /* Deal with function syms. */
4786 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4787 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4788 || h->needs_plt)
4789 {
4790 bool local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4791 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4792 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4793 function symbol is local. */
4794 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4795 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4796
4797 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4798 won't need a .plt entry. */
4799 struct plt_entry *ent;
4800 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4801 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4802 break;
4803 if (ent == NULL
4804 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4805 && local
4806 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4807 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4808 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4809 {
4810 /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4811
4812 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4813 can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4814 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4815
4816 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4817
4818 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4819 will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4820 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4821 h->needs_plt = 0;
4822 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4823 }
4824 else
4825 {
4826 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4827 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4828 executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4829 be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4830 (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4831 through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4832 reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4833 resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4834 than link time. */
4835 if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4836 || (h->non_got_ref
4837 && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4838 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4839 && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4840 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4841 && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4842 {
4843 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4844 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4845 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4846 if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4847 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4848 }
4849 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4850 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4851 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4852 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4853 }
4854 h->protected_def = 0;
4855 /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4856 return true;
4857 }
4858 else
4859 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4860
4861 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4862 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4863 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4864 if (h->is_weakalias)
4865 {
4866 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4867 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4868 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4869 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4870 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4871 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4872 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4873 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4874 return true;
4875 }
4876
4877 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4878 is not a function. */
4879
4880 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4881 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4882 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4883 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4884 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4885 {
4886 h->protected_def = 0;
4887 return true;
4888 }
4889
4890 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4891 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4892 if (!h->non_got_ref)
4893 {
4894 h->protected_def = 0;
4895 return true;
4896 }
4897
4898 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4899 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4900 definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4901 are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4902 if (h->protected_def)
4903 {
4904 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4905 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4906 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4907 && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4908 && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4909 htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4910 return true;
4911 }
4912
4913 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4914 if (info->nocopyreloc)
4915 return true;
4916
4917 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4918 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4919 We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4920 doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4921 relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4922 executable. */
4923 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4924 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4925 && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4926 && !h->def_regular
4927 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4928 return true;
4929
4930 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4931 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4932 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4933 object will contain position independent code, so all references
4934 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4935 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4936 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4937 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4938 same memory location for the variable.
4939
4940 Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4941 must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4942 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4943 s = htab->dynsbss;
4944 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4945 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4946 else
4947 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4948 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4949
4950 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4951 {
4952 asection *srel;
4953
4954 /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4955 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4956 and into the runtime process image. */
4957 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4958 srel = htab->relsbss;
4959 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4960 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4961 else
4962 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4963 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4964 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4965 h->needs_copy = 1;
4966 }
4967
4968 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4969 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4970 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4971 }
4972
4973 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4975 xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4976 specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4977 is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4978 xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4979
4980 static bool
4981 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4982 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4983 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4984 {
4985 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4986 size_t len1, len2, len3;
4987 char *name;
4988 const char *stub;
4989 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4990
4991 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4992 stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4993 else
4994 stub = ".plt_call32.";
4995
4996 len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4997 len2 = strlen (stub);
4998 len3 = 0;
4999 if (ent->sec)
5000 len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
5001 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
5002 if (name == NULL)
5003 return false;
5004 sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
5005 if (ent->sec)
5006 memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
5007 memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
5008 memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
5009 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, true, false, false);
5010 if (sh == NULL)
5011 return false;
5012 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5013 {
5014 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5015 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5016 sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
5017 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5018 sh->def_regular = 1;
5019 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5020 sh->forced_local = 1;
5021 sh->non_elf = 0;
5022 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5023 }
5024 return true;
5025 }
5026
5027 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
5028 Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
5029
5030 static bfd_vma
5031 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
5032 {
5033 bfd_vma where;
5034 unsigned int max_before_header;
5035
5036 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5037 {
5038 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5039 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5040 }
5041 else
5042 {
5043 max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5044 if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5045 {
5046 where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5047 htab->got_gap -= need;
5048 }
5049 else
5050 {
5051 if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5052 && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5053 {
5054 htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5055 htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5056 }
5057 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5058 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5059 }
5060 }
5061 return where;
5062 }
5063
5064 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5065 TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5066
5067 static inline unsigned int
5068 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5069 {
5070 unsigned int need;
5071 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5072 need = 4;
5073 else
5074 {
5075 need = 0;
5076 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5077 need += 8;
5078 if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5079 need += 4;
5080 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5081 need += 4;
5082 }
5083 return need;
5084 }
5085
5086 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5087
5088 static bool
5089 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5090 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5091 {
5092 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5093
5094 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5095 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5096 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5097 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5098 && h->dynindx == -1
5099 && !h->forced_local
5100 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5101 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5102 return true;
5103 }
5104
5105 /* Choose whether to use htab->iplt or htab->pltlocal rather than the
5106 usual htab->elf.splt section for a PLT entry. */
5107
5108 static inline
5109 bool use_local_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5110 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5111 {
5112 return (h == NULL
5113 || h->dynindx == -1
5114 || !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created);
5115 }
5116
5117 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5118
5119 static bool
5120 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5121 {
5122 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5123 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5124 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5125 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5126
5127 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5128 return true;
5129
5130 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5131 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5132 if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5133 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5134 && !eh->elf.def_regular
5135 && eh->elf.protected_def
5136 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5137 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5138 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5139 {
5140 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5141 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5142 return false;
5143
5144 unsigned int need = got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5145 unsigned int rel_need = need * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5146 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5147 {
5148 if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5149 /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5150 always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5151 a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5152 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5153 else
5154 {
5155 need += 8;
5156 rel_need += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5157 }
5158 }
5159 if (need == 0)
5160 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5161 else
5162 {
5163 eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5164 if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
5165 && !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5166 && bfd_link_executable (info)
5167 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5168 && !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root))
5169 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5170 && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5171 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5172 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5173 {
5174 asection *rsec;
5175
5176 rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5177 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5178 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5179 rsec->size += rel_need;
5180 }
5181 }
5182 }
5183 else
5184 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5185
5186 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5187 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5188 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5189 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5190 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5191
5192 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5193 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5194 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5195 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5196
5197 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5198 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5199 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5200 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5201
5202 if (h->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5203 ;
5204
5205 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5206 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5207 defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5208 space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5209 changes. */
5210 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5211 {
5212 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5213 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5214 generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5215 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5216 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5217 then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5218 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5219 {
5220 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5221
5222 for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5223 {
5224 p->count -= p->pc_count;
5225 p->pc_count = 0;
5226 if (p->count == 0)
5227 *pp = p->next;
5228 else
5229 pp = &p->next;
5230 }
5231 }
5232
5233 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5234 {
5235 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5236
5237 for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5238 {
5239 if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5240 *pp = p->next;
5241 else
5242 pp = &p->next;
5243 }
5244 }
5245
5246 if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5247 {
5248 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5249 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5250 return false;
5251 }
5252 }
5253 else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5254 {
5255 /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5256 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5257 dynamic. */
5258 if ((h->dynamic_adjusted
5259 || (h->ref_regular
5260 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5261 && (info->dynamic_undefined_weak > 0
5262 || !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))))
5263 && !h->def_regular
5264 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5265 && !(h->protected_def
5266 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5267 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5268 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5269 {
5270 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5271 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5272 return false;
5273
5274 if (h->dynindx == -1)
5275 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5276 }
5277 else
5278 h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5279 }
5280
5281 /* Allocate space. */
5282 for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5283 if (!discarded_section (p->sec))
5284 {
5285 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5286 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5287 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5288 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5289 }
5290
5291 /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5292 We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5293 a) is dynamic, or
5294 b) is an ifunc, or
5295 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5296 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5297 if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1)
5298 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5299 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5300 || (h->needs_plt
5301 && h->def_regular
5302 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5303 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5304 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5305 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5306 {
5307 struct plt_entry *ent;
5308 bool doneone = false;
5309 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5310
5311 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5312 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5313 {
5314 asection *s;
5315 bool dyn;
5316
5317 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5318 return false;
5319
5320 dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
5321 s = htab->elf.splt;
5322 if (!dyn)
5323 {
5324 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5325 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5326 else
5327 s = htab->pltlocal;
5328 }
5329
5330 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5331 {
5332 if (!doneone)
5333 {
5334 plt_offset = s->size;
5335 s->size += 4;
5336 }
5337 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5338
5339 if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5340 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5341 else
5342 {
5343 s = htab->glink;
5344 if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5345 {
5346 glink_offset = s->size;
5347 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5348 }
5349 if (!doneone
5350 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5351 && h->def_dynamic
5352 && !h->def_regular)
5353 {
5354 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5355 h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5356 }
5357 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5358
5359 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5360 && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5361 return false;
5362 }
5363 }
5364 else
5365 {
5366 if (!doneone)
5367 {
5368 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5369 for the special first entry. */
5370 if (s->size == 0)
5371 s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5372
5373 /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5374 parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5375 and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5376 word available at the end. */
5377 plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5378 + (htab->plt_slot_size
5379 * ((s->size
5380 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5381 / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5382
5383 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5384 file, and we are not generating a shared
5385 library, then set the symbol to this location
5386 in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5387 relocations, and is required to make
5388 function pointers compare as equal between
5389 the normal executable and the shared library. */
5390 if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5391 && h->def_dynamic
5392 && !h->def_regular)
5393 {
5394 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5395 h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5396 }
5397
5398 /* Make room for this entry. */
5399 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5400 /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5401 is allocated. */
5402 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5403 && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5404 / htab->plt_entry_size
5405 > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5406 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5407 }
5408 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5409 }
5410
5411 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5412 if (!doneone)
5413 {
5414 if (!dyn)
5415 {
5416 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5417 {
5418 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5419 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5420 }
5421 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5422 {
5423 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5424 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5425 }
5426 }
5427 else
5428 {
5429 htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5430
5431 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5432 {
5433 /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5434 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5435 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5436 {
5437 if (ent->plt.offset
5438 == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5439 {
5440 htab->srelplt2->size
5441 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5442 * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5443 }
5444
5445 htab->srelplt2->size
5446 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5447 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5448 }
5449
5450 /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5451 .got.plt. */
5452 htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5453 }
5454 }
5455 doneone = true;
5456 }
5457 }
5458 else
5459 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5460
5461 if (!doneone)
5462 {
5463 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5464 h->needs_plt = 0;
5465 }
5466 }
5467 else
5468 {
5469 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5470 h->needs_plt = 0;
5471 }
5472
5473 return true;
5474 }
5475
5476 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5477 {
5478 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5479 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5480 1, /* CIE version. */
5481 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5482 4, /* Code alignment. */
5483 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5484 65, /* RA reg. */
5485 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5486 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5487 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5488 };
5489
5490 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5491
5492 static bool
5493 ppc_elf_late_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5494 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5495 {
5496 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5497 asection *s;
5498 bool relocs;
5499 bfd *ibfd;
5500
5501 #ifdef DEBUG
5502 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_late_size_sections called\n");
5503 #endif
5504
5505 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5506 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
5507 return true;
5508
5509 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5510 {
5511 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5512 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5513 {
5514 s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5515 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5516 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5517 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5518 }
5519 }
5520
5521 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5522 htab->got_header_size = 16;
5523 else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5524 htab->got_header_size = 12;
5525
5526 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5527 relocs. */
5528 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5529 {
5530 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5531 bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5532 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5533 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5534 char *lgot_masks;
5535 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5536 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5537 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
5538 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
5539
5540 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5541 continue;
5542
5543 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5544 {
5545 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5546
5547 for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5548 elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5549 p != NULL;
5550 p = p->next)
5551 {
5552 if (discarded_section (p->sec))
5553 {
5554 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5555 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5556 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5557 the relocs too. */
5558 }
5559 else if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
5560 && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5561 ".tls_vars") == 0)
5562 {
5563 /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5564 handled specially by the loader. */
5565 }
5566 else if (p->count != 0)
5567 {
5568 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5569 if (p->ifunc)
5570 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5571 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5572 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5573 & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5574 == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5575 {
5576 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5577 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5578 p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5579 }
5580 }
5581 }
5582 }
5583
5584 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5585 if (!local_got)
5586 continue;
5587
5588 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5589 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5590 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5591 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5592 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5593 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5594 local_syms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
5595 if (local_syms == NULL && locsymcount != 0)
5596 {
5597 local_syms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr, locsymcount,
5598 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
5599 if (local_syms == NULL)
5600 return false;
5601 }
5602
5603 for (isym = local_syms;
5604 local_got < end_local_got;
5605 ++local_got, ++lgot_masks, ++isym)
5606 if (*local_got > 0)
5607 {
5608 unsigned int need;
5609 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5610 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5611 need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5612 if (need == 0)
5613 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5614 else
5615 {
5616 *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5617 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5618 && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
5619 && bfd_link_executable (info))
5620 && isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
5621 {
5622 asection *srel;
5623
5624 need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5625 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5626 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5627 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5628 srel->size += need;
5629 }
5630 }
5631 }
5632 else
5633 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5634
5635 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5636 continue;
5637
5638 /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5639 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5640 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5641 {
5642 struct plt_entry *ent;
5643 bool doneone = false;
5644 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5645
5646 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5647 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5648 {
5649 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5650 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5651 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5652 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5653 {
5654 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5655 continue;
5656 }
5657 else
5658 s = htab->pltlocal;
5659
5660 if (!doneone)
5661 {
5662 plt_offset = s->size;
5663 s->size += 4;
5664 }
5665 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5666
5667 if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5668 {
5669 s = htab->glink;
5670 glink_offset = s->size;
5671 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5672 }
5673 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5674
5675 if (!doneone)
5676 {
5677 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5678 {
5679 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5680 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5681 }
5682 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5683 {
5684 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5685 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5686 }
5687 doneone = true;
5688 }
5689 }
5690 else
5691 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5692 }
5693
5694 if (local_syms != NULL
5695 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
5696 {
5697 if (!info->keep_memory)
5698 free (local_syms);
5699 else
5700 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
5701 }
5702 }
5703
5704 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5705 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5706
5707 if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5708 {
5709 htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5710 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5711 htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5712 }
5713 else
5714 htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5715
5716 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5717 {
5718 unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5719
5720 /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5721 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5722 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5723 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5724 if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5725 {
5726 g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5727 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5728 g_o_t += 4;
5729 htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5730 }
5731
5732 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5733 }
5734 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5735 {
5736 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5737
5738 sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5739 sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5740 }
5741 if (info->emitrelocations)
5742 {
5743 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5744
5745 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5746 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5747 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5748 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5749 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5750 }
5751
5752 if (htab->glink != NULL
5753 && htab->glink->size != 0
5754 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5755 {
5756 htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5757 /* Space for the branch table. */
5758 htab->glink->size
5759 += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5760 /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5761 htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5762 ? 63 : 15);
5763 htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5764
5765 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5766 {
5767 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5768 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5769 true, false, false);
5770 if (sh == NULL)
5771 return false;
5772 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5773 {
5774 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5775 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5776 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5777 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5778 sh->def_regular = 1;
5779 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5780 sh->forced_local = 1;
5781 sh->non_elf = 0;
5782 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5783 }
5784 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5785 true, false, false);
5786 if (sh == NULL)
5787 return false;
5788 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5789 {
5790 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5791 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5792 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5793 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5794 sh->def_regular = 1;
5795 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5796 sh->forced_local = 1;
5797 sh->non_elf = 0;
5798 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5799 }
5800 }
5801 }
5802
5803 if (htab->glink != NULL
5804 && htab->glink->size != 0
5805 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5806 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5807 && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5808 {
5809 s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5810 s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5811 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5812 {
5813 s->size += 4;
5814 if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5815 s->size += 4;
5816 }
5817 }
5818
5819 /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5820 Allocate memory for them. */
5821 relocs = false;
5822 for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5823 {
5824 bool strip_section = true;
5825
5826 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5827 continue;
5828
5829 if (s == htab->elf.splt
5830 || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5831 {
5832 /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5833 we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5834 It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5835 if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5836 strip_section = false;
5837 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5838 comment below. */
5839 }
5840 else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5841 || s == htab->pltlocal
5842 || s == htab->glink
5843 || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5844 || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5845 || s == htab->sbss
5846 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5847 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5848 || s == htab->dynsbss)
5849 {
5850 /* Strip these too. */
5851 }
5852 else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5853 || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5854 {
5855 strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5856 }
5857 else if (startswith (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
5858 {
5859 if (s->size != 0)
5860 {
5861 /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5862 relocs = true;
5863
5864 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5865 to copy relocs into the output file. */
5866 s->reloc_count = 0;
5867 }
5868 }
5869 else
5870 {
5871 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5872 continue;
5873 }
5874
5875 if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5876 {
5877 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5878 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5879 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5880 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5881 before the linker maps input sections to output
5882 sections. The linker does that before
5883 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5884 function which decides whether anything needs to go
5885 into these sections. */
5886 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5887 continue;
5888 }
5889
5890 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5891 continue;
5892
5893 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5894 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5895 if (s->contents == NULL)
5896 return false;
5897 }
5898
5899 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5900 {
5901 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5902 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5903 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5904 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5905 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5906 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5907 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5908
5909 if (!_bfd_elf_maybe_vxworks_add_dynamic_tags (output_bfd, info,
5910 relocs))
5911 return false;
5912
5913 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5914 && htab->glink != NULL
5915 && htab->glink->size != 0)
5916 {
5917 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5918 return false;
5919 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5920 && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5921 && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5922 && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5923 return false;
5924 }
5925 }
5926 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5927
5928 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5929 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5930 {
5931 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5932 bfd_vma val;
5933
5934 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5935 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5936 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5937 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5938 /* FDE length. */
5939 val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5940 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5941 p += 4;
5942 /* CIE pointer. */
5943 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5944 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5945 p += 4;
5946 /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5947 p += 4;
5948 /* .glink size. */
5949 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5950 p += 4;
5951 /* Augmentation. */
5952 p += 1;
5953
5954 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5955 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5956 {
5957 bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5958 if (adv < 64)
5959 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5960 else if (adv < 256)
5961 {
5962 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5963 *p++ = adv;
5964 }
5965 else if (adv < 65536)
5966 {
5967 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5968 bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5969 p += 2;
5970 }
5971 else
5972 {
5973 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5974 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5975 p += 4;
5976 }
5977 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5978 *p++ = 65;
5979 p++;
5980 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5981 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5982 *p++ = 65;
5983 }
5984 BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5985 == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5986 }
5987
5988 return true;
5989 }
5990
5991 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5992 if it looks like nothing is using them. */
5993
5994 static void
5995 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
5996 {
5997 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
5998
5999 if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
6000 {
6001 asection *s;
6002
6003 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
6004 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6005 {
6006 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
6007 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6008 {
6009 sda->def_regular = 0;
6010 /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
6011 sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
6012 sda->forced_local = 0;
6013 }
6014 }
6015 }
6016 }
6017
6018 void
6019 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6020 {
6021 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6022
6023 if (htab != NULL)
6024 {
6025 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6026 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6027 }
6028 }
6029
6030
6031 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6032
6033 static bool
6034 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6035 {
6036 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6037 && !h->def_regular
6038 && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6039 || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6040 return false;
6041
6042 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6043 }
6044
6045 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6047
6048 /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6049 used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6050 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6051 {
6052 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6053 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6054 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6055 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6056 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6057 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6058 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6059 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6060 };
6061
6062 static const int stub_entry[] =
6063 {
6064 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6065 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6066 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6067 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6068 };
6069
6070 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6071 {
6072 unsigned int workaround_size;
6073 unsigned int picfixup_size;
6074 };
6075
6076 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6077 icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6078 space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6079 add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6080
6081 static bool
6082 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6083 asection *isec,
6084 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6085 bool *again)
6086 {
6087 struct one_branch_fixup
6088 {
6089 struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6090 asection *tsec;
6091 /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6092 relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6093 bfd_vma toff;
6094 bfd_vma trampoff;
6095 };
6096
6097 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6098 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6099 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6100 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6101 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6102 struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6103 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6104 unsigned changes = 0;
6105 bool workaround_change;
6106 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6107 bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6108 asection *got2;
6109 bool maybe_pasted;
6110
6111 *again = false;
6112
6113 /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6114 if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6115 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6116 || (isec->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0
6117 || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6118 || isec->size < 4)
6119 return true;
6120
6121 /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6122 do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6123 anyway. */
6124 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6125 return true;
6126
6127 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6128 if (htab == NULL)
6129 return true;
6130
6131 isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6132 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6133 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6134 trampbase = isec->size;
6135
6136 BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6137 || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6138 isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6139
6140 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6141 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6142 {
6143 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6144 {
6145 elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6146 = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6147 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6148 return false;
6149 }
6150 relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6151 trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6152 }
6153
6154 maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6155 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6156 /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6157 trampoff = trampbase;
6158 if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6159 trampoff += 4;
6160
6161 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6162 picfixup_size = 0;
6163 if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6164 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6165 {
6166 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6167 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6168 {
6169 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6170 link_info->keep_memory);
6171 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6172 goto error_return;
6173 }
6174
6175 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6176
6177 irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6178 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6179 {
6180 unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6181 bfd_vma toff, roff;
6182 asection *tsec;
6183 struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6184 size_t insn_offset = 0;
6185 bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val, reladdr;
6186 bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6187 unsigned long t0;
6188 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6189 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6190 struct plt_entry **plist;
6191 unsigned char sym_type;
6192
6193 switch (r_type)
6194 {
6195 case R_PPC_REL24:
6196 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6197 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6198 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6199 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6200 break;
6201
6202 case R_PPC_REL14:
6203 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6204 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6205 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6206 break;
6207
6208 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6209 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6210 break;
6211 continue;
6212
6213 default:
6214 continue;
6215 }
6216
6217 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6218 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6219 ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6220 goto error_return;
6221
6222 if (isym != NULL)
6223 {
6224 if (tsec != NULL)
6225 ;
6226 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6227 tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6228 else
6229 continue;
6230
6231 toff = isym->st_value;
6232 sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6233 }
6234 else
6235 {
6236 if (tsec != NULL)
6237 toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6238 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6239 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6240 {
6241 unsigned long indx;
6242
6243 indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6244 tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6245 toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6246 }
6247 else
6248 continue;
6249
6250 /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6251 optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6252 branch stub in that case. */
6253 if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6254 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6255 && irel != internal_relocs)
6256 {
6257 unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6258 unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6259 unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6260
6261 /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6262 R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6263 on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6264 mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6265 if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6266 {
6267 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6268
6269 if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6270 {
6271 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6272 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6273 char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6274 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6275 tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6276 }
6277 }
6278 else
6279 {
6280 struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6281 = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6282
6283 while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6284 || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6285 th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6286
6287 tls_mask
6288 = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6289 }
6290
6291 /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6292 optimised away. */
6293 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6294 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6295 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6296 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6297 continue;
6298 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6299 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6300 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6301 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6302 continue;
6303 }
6304
6305 sym_type = h->type;
6306 }
6307
6308 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6309 {
6310 if (h != NULL
6311 && !h->def_regular
6312 && h->protected_def
6313 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6314 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6315 picfixup_size += 12;
6316 continue;
6317 }
6318
6319 /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6320 match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6321 but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6322 destination used here may be incorrect. */
6323 plist = NULL;
6324 if (h != NULL)
6325 {
6326 /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6327 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6328 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6329 plist = &h->plt.plist;
6330 }
6331 else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6332 && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6333 {
6334 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6335 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6336 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6337 plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6338 }
6339 if (plist != NULL)
6340 {
6341 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6342 struct plt_entry *ent;
6343
6344 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6345 addend = irel->r_addend;
6346 ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6347 if (ent != NULL)
6348 {
6349 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6350 || h == NULL
6351 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6352 || h->dynindx == -1)
6353 {
6354 tsec = htab->glink;
6355 toff = ent->glink_offset;
6356 }
6357 else
6358 {
6359 tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6360 toff = ent->plt.offset;
6361 }
6362 }
6363 }
6364
6365 /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6366 no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6367 branch overflow. */
6368 if (tsec == isec)
6369 continue;
6370
6371 /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6372 undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6373 support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6374 putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6375 branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6376 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6377 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6378 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6379 && irel->r_addend != 0)
6380 continue;
6381
6382 /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6383 SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6384 attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6385 branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6386 reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6387 if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6388 {
6389 /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6390 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6391 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6392 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6393 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6394
6395 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6396 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6397 the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6398 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6399 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6400 location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6401 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6402 a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6403 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6404 location of interest is just "sym". */
6405 if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6406 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6407 toff += irel->r_addend;
6408
6409 toff
6410 = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6411 elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6412 toff);
6413
6414 if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6415 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6416 toff += irel->r_addend;
6417 }
6418 /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6419 else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6420 toff += irel->r_addend;
6421
6422 /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6423 if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6424 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6425 || tsec->output_section == NULL
6426 || (tsec->owner != NULL
6427 && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6428 continue;
6429
6430 roff = irel->r_offset;
6431 reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6432
6433 /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6434 relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6435 fixup can be created at final link.
6436 The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6437 of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6438 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6439 && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6440 < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6441 continue;
6442
6443 /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6444 if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6445 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6446 /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6447 final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6448 || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6449 {
6450 bfd_vma symaddr;
6451
6452 symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6453 if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6454 < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6455 continue;
6456 }
6457
6458 /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6459 for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6460 if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6461 break;
6462
6463 if (f == NULL)
6464 {
6465 size_t size;
6466 unsigned long stub_rtype;
6467
6468 val = trampoff - roff;
6469 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6470 /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6471 one. We'll report an error later. */
6472 continue;
6473
6474 if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6475 {
6476 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6477 insn_offset = 12;
6478 }
6479 else
6480 {
6481 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6482 insn_offset = 0;
6483 }
6484 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6485 if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6486 || tsec == htab->glink)
6487 {
6488 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6489 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6490 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6491 }
6492
6493 /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6494 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6495 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6496 stub_rtype);
6497 irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6498 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6499 && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6500 irel->r_addend = 0;
6501
6502 /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6503 f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6504 f->next = branch_fixups;
6505 f->tsec = tsec;
6506 f->toff = toff;
6507 f->trampoff = trampoff;
6508 branch_fixups = f;
6509
6510 trampoff += size;
6511 changes++;
6512 }
6513 else
6514 {
6515 val = f->trampoff - roff;
6516 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6517 continue;
6518
6519 /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6520 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6521 }
6522
6523 link_info->callbacks->minfo
6524 (_("%pB: Adjusting branch at 0x%V towards \"%s\" in section %s\n"),
6525 abfd, reladdr,
6526 (h && h->root.root.string? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"),
6527 f->tsec->name);
6528
6529 /* Get the section contents. */
6530 if (contents == NULL)
6531 {
6532 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6533 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6534 contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6535 /* Go get them off disk. */
6536 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6537 goto error_return;
6538 }
6539
6540 /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6541 hit_addr = contents + roff;
6542 switch (r_type)
6543 {
6544 case R_PPC_REL24:
6545 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6546 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6547 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6548 t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6549 t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6550 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6551 break;
6552
6553 case R_PPC_REL14:
6554 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6555 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6556 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6557 t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6558 t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6559 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6560 break;
6561 }
6562 }
6563
6564 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6565 {
6566 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6567 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6568 free (f);
6569 }
6570 }
6571
6572 workaround_change = false;
6573 newsize = trampoff;
6574 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6575 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6576 || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6577 {
6578 bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6579 unsigned int crossings;
6580 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6581
6582 addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6583 end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6584 addr &= -pagesize;
6585 crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6586 if (crossings != 0)
6587 {
6588 /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6589 not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6590 previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6591 newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6592 newsize += crossings * 16;
6593 if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6594 {
6595 relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6596 workaround_change = true;
6597 }
6598 /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6599 isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6600 }
6601 newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6602 }
6603
6604 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6605 {
6606 picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6607 if (picfixup_size != 0)
6608 relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6609 newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6610 }
6611
6612 if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6613 isec->size = newsize;
6614
6615 if (isymbuf != NULL
6616 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6617 {
6618 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6619 free (isymbuf);
6620 else
6621 {
6622 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6623 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6624 }
6625 }
6626
6627 if (contents != NULL
6628 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6629 {
6630 if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6631 free (contents);
6632 else
6633 {
6634 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6635 elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6636 }
6637 }
6638
6639 changes += picfixup_size;
6640 if (changes != 0)
6641 {
6642 /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6643 information for the trampolines. */
6644 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6645 Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6646 * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6647 unsigned ix;
6648
6649 if (!new_relocs)
6650 goto error_return;
6651 memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6652 isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6653 for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6654 {
6655 irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6656
6657 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6658 }
6659 if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6660 free (internal_relocs);
6661 elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6662 isec->reloc_count += changes;
6663 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6664 rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6665 }
6666 else if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6667 free (internal_relocs);
6668
6669 *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6670 return true;
6671
6672 error_return:
6673 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6674 {
6675 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6676 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6677 free (f);
6678 }
6679 if ((unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6680 free (isymbuf);
6681 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6682 free (contents);
6683 if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6684 free (internal_relocs);
6685 return false;
6686 }
6687
6688 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6690 discarded sections. */
6691
6692 static unsigned int
6693 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6694 {
6695 if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6696 return 0;
6697
6698 if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6699 return 0;
6700
6701 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6702 }
6703
6704 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6706
6707 static bfd_vma
6708 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6709 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6710 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6711 bfd_vma relocation,
6712 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6713 {
6714 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6715
6716 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6717
6718 if (h != NULL)
6719 {
6720 /* Handle global symbol. */
6721 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6722
6723 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6724 BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6725 linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6726 }
6727 else
6728 {
6729 /* Handle local symbol. */
6730 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6731
6732 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6733 BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6734 linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6735 }
6736
6737 linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6738 rel->r_addend,
6739 lsect);
6740 BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6741
6742 /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6743 as a "written" flag. */
6744 if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6745 {
6746 bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6747 relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6748 lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6749 linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6750 }
6751
6752 relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6753 + lsect->section->output_offset
6754 + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6755 - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6756
6757 #ifdef DEBUG
6758 fprintf (stderr,
6759 "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6760 lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6761 #endif
6762
6763 return relocation;
6764 }
6765
6766 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6767 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6768 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6769
6770 static void
6771 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6772 asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6773 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6774 {
6775 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6776 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6777 bfd_vma plt;
6778 unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6779
6780 if (h != NULL
6781 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6782 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6783 {
6784 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6785 p += 4;
6786 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6787 p += 4;
6788 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6789 p += 4;
6790 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6791 p += 4;
6792 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6793 p += 4;
6794 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6795 p += 4;
6796 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6797 p += 4;
6798 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6799 p += 4;
6800 }
6801
6802 plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6803 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6804 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6805
6806 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6807 {
6808 bfd_vma got = 0;
6809
6810 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6811 got = (ent->addend
6812 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6813 + ent->sec->output_offset);
6814 else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6815 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6816
6817 plt -= got;
6818
6819 if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6820 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6821 else
6822 {
6823 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6824 p += 4;
6825 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6826 }
6827 }
6828 else
6829 {
6830 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6831 p += 4;
6832 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6833 }
6834 p += 4;
6835 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6836 p += 4;
6837 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6838 p += 4;
6839 while (p < end)
6840 {
6841 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6842 p += 4;
6843 }
6844 }
6845
6846 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6847
6848 static bool
6849 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6850 {
6851 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6852 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6853 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6854 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6855 }
6856
6857 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6858 the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6859 REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6860
6861 unsigned int
6862 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6863 {
6864 unsigned int rtra;
6865
6866 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6867 return 0;
6868
6869 if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6870 rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6871 else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6872 rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6873 else
6874 return 0;
6875
6876 if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6877 /* add -> addi. */
6878 insn = 14 << 26;
6879 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6880 && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6881 || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6882 && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6883 /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6884 insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6885 else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6886 /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6887 insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6888 else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6889 /* lwax -> lwa. */
6890 insn = (58u << 26) | 2;
6891 else
6892 return 0;
6893 insn |= rtra;
6894 return insn;
6895 }
6896
6897 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6898 the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6899 thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6900
6901 unsigned int
6902 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6903 {
6904 if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6905 && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6906 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6907 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6908 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6909 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6910 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6911 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6912 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6913 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6914 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6915 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6916 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6917 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6918 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6919 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6920 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6921 && (insn & 3) != 1)
6922 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6923 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6924 {
6925 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6926 }
6927 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6928 && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6929 || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6930 || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6931 {
6932 insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6933 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6934 if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6935 insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6936 }
6937 else
6938 insn = 0;
6939 return insn;
6940 }
6941
6942 static bool
6943 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6944 {
6945 return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6946 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6947 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6948 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6949 }
6950
6951 static bool
6952 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6953 {
6954 return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6955 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6956 && (insn & 3) == 1));
6957 }
6958
6959 static bool
6960 swap_reloc_out (bfd *obfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, bfd_byte *loc, asection *s)
6961 {
6962 if ((size_t) (loc - s->contents) >= s->size)
6963 return false;
6964 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (obfd, rel, loc);
6965 return true;
6966 }
6967
6968 static bool
6969 count_and_swap_reloc_out (bfd *obfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, asection *s)
6970 {
6971 bfd_byte *loc = s->contents;
6972 loc += s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
6973 return swap_reloc_out (obfd, rel, loc, s);
6974 }
6975
6976 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6977 to handle the relocations for a section.
6978
6979 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6980 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6981 zero.
6982
6983 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6984 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6985 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6986 necessary.
6987
6988 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6989 address or the reloc symbol index.
6990
6991 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6992
6993 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6994 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6995
6996 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6997 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6998
6999 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
7000 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
7001 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
7002 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
7003 accordingly. */
7004
7005 static int
7006 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
7007 struct bfd_link_info *info,
7008 bfd *input_bfd,
7009 asection *input_section,
7010 bfd_byte *contents,
7011 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7012 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7013 asection **local_sections)
7014 {
7015 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7016 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
7017 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7018 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7019 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
7020 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
7021 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
7022 asection *got2;
7023 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
7024 bool ret = true;
7025 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
7026 bool is_vxworks_tls;
7027 unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
7028 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
7029
7030 #ifdef DEBUG
7031 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
7032 "%ld relocations%s",
7033 input_bfd, input_section,
7034 (long) input_section->reloc_count,
7035 (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
7036 #endif
7037
7038 if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
7039 {
7040 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7041 return false;
7042 }
7043
7044 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7045
7046 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7047 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7048 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7049
7050 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7051 local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7052 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7053 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7054 /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7055 specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7056 is_vxworks_tls = (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7057 && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7058 ".tls_vars"));
7059 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7060 relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7061 rel = wrel = relocs;
7062 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7063 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7064 {
7065 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7066 bfd_vma addend;
7067 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7068 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7069 asection *sec;
7070 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7071 const char *sym_name;
7072 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7073 unsigned long r_symndx;
7074 bfd_vma relocation;
7075 bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7076 bool unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7077 bool warned;
7078 unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7079 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7080 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7081
7082 again:
7083 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7084 sym = NULL;
7085 sec = NULL;
7086 h = NULL;
7087 unresolved_reloc = false;
7088 warned = false;
7089 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7090
7091 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7092 {
7093 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7094 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7095 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7096
7097 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7098 }
7099 else
7100 {
7101 bool ignored;
7102
7103 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7104 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7105 h, sec, relocation,
7106 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7107
7108 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7109 }
7110
7111 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7112 {
7113 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7114 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7115 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7116 howto = NULL;
7117 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7118 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7119
7120 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7121 contents, rel->r_offset);
7122 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7123 wrel->r_info = 0;
7124 wrel->r_addend = 0;
7125
7126 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7127 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7128 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7129 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7130 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7131 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7132 wrel--;
7133
7134 continue;
7135 }
7136
7137 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7138 {
7139 if (got2 != NULL
7140 && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7141 && rel->r_addend != 0)
7142 {
7143 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7144 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7145 rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7146 }
7147 if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7148 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7149 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7150 goto copy_reloc;
7151 }
7152
7153 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7154 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7155 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7156 for the final instruction stream. */
7157 tls_mask = 0;
7158 tls_gd = 0;
7159 if (h != NULL)
7160 tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7161 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7162 {
7163 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7164 char *lgot_masks;
7165 local_plt
7166 = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7167 lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7168 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7169 }
7170
7171 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7172 if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7173 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7174 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7175 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7176 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7177 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7178 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7179 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7180 abort ();
7181 switch (r_type)
7182 {
7183 default:
7184 break;
7185
7186 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7187 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7188 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7189 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
7190 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7191 {
7192 bfd_vma insn;
7193
7194 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7195 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7196 insn &= 31 << 21;
7197 insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7198 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7199 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7200 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7201 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7202 }
7203 break;
7204
7205 case R_PPC_TLS:
7206 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7207 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
7208 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7209 {
7210 bfd_vma insn;
7211
7212 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7213 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7214 if (insn == 0)
7215 abort ();
7216 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7217 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7218 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7219
7220 /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7221 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7222 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7223 }
7224 break;
7225
7226 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7227 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7228 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7229 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7230 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7231 goto tls_gdld_hi;
7232 break;
7233
7234 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7235 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7236 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7237 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7238 {
7239 tls_gdld_hi:
7240 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7241 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7242 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7243 else
7244 {
7245 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7246 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7247 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7248 }
7249 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7250 }
7251 break;
7252
7253 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7254 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7255 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7256 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7257 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7258 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7259 break;
7260
7261 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7262 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7263 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7264 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7265 {
7266 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7267 bfd_vma offset;
7268
7269 tls_ldgd_opt:
7270 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7271 /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7272 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7273 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7274 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7275 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7276 if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
7277 && rel + 1 < relend
7278 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7279 htab->tls_get_addr))
7280 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7281 /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7282 the destination reg. It may be something other than
7283 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7284 intervening code. */
7285 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7286 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7287 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7288 {
7289 /* IE */
7290 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7291 insn1 |= 32u << 26; /* lwz */
7292 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
7293 && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
7294 {
7295 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7296 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7297 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7298 }
7299 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7300 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7301 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7302 }
7303 else
7304 {
7305 /* LE */
7306 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7307 insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7308 if (tls_gd == 0)
7309 {
7310 /* Was an LD reloc. */
7311 for (r_symndx = 0;
7312 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7313 r_symndx++)
7314 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7315 break;
7316 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7317 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7318 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7319 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7320 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7321 + sec->output_offset
7322 + sec->output_section->vma);
7323 }
7324 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7325 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7326 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
7327 && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
7328 {
7329 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7330 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7331 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7332 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7333 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7334 }
7335 }
7336 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7337 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7338 if (tls_gd == 0)
7339 {
7340 /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7341 in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7342 goto again;
7343 }
7344 }
7345 break;
7346
7347 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7348 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7349 && rel + 1 < relend
7350 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7351 {
7352 unsigned int insn2;
7353 bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7354
7355 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7356 {
7357 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7358 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7359 break;
7360 }
7361
7362 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7363 {
7364 /* IE */
7365 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7366 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7367 }
7368 else
7369 {
7370 /* LE */
7371 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7372 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7373 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7374 }
7375 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7376 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7377 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7378 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7379 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7380 }
7381 break;
7382
7383 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7384 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7385 && rel + 1 < relend
7386 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7387 {
7388 unsigned int insn2;
7389
7390 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7391 {
7392 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7393 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7394 break;
7395 }
7396
7397 for (r_symndx = 0;
7398 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7399 r_symndx++)
7400 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7401 break;
7402 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7403 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7404 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7405 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7406 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7407 + sec->output_offset
7408 + sec->output_section->vma);
7409
7410 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7411 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7412 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7413 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7414 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7415 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7416 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7417 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7418 goto again;
7419 }
7420 break;
7421 }
7422
7423 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7424 branch_bit = 0;
7425 switch (r_type)
7426 {
7427 default:
7428 break;
7429
7430 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7431 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7432 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7433 branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7434 /* Fall through. */
7435
7436 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7437 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7438 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7439 if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
7440 {
7441 unsigned int insn;
7442
7443 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7444 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7445 insn |= branch_bit;
7446
7447 from = (rel->r_offset
7448 + input_section->output_offset
7449 + input_section->output_section->vma);
7450
7451 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7452 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7453 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7454
7455 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7456 }
7457 break;
7458
7459 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7460 if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7461 {
7462 unsigned int insn;
7463
7464 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7465 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7466 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26
7467 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7468 {
7469 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7470 {
7471 /* Convert addis to lis. */
7472 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7473 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7474 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7475 }
7476 }
7477 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7478 info->callbacks->einfo
7479 (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7480 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7481 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7482 }
7483 break;
7484 }
7485
7486 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7487 && h != NULL
7488 && !h->def_regular
7489 && h->protected_def
7490 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7491 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7492 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7493 {
7494 /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7495 variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7496 unsigned int insn;
7497
7498 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA
7499 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7500 {
7501 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7502 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7503 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7504 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7505 {
7506 bfd_byte *p;
7507 bfd_vma off;
7508 bfd_vma got_addr;
7509
7510 p = (contents + input_section->size
7511 - relax_info->workaround_size
7512 - relax_info->picfixup_size
7513 + picfixup_size);
7514 off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7515 if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7516 info->callbacks->einfo
7517 (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7518 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7519
7520 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7521 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7522 got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7523 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7524 + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7525 wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7526 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7527 wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7528 insn &= ~0xffff;
7529 insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7530 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7531
7532 /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7533 insn &= ~0xffff;
7534 insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7535 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7536 insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7537 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7538
7539 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7540 picfixup_size += 12;
7541
7542 /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7543 output is reasonable. */
7544 memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7545 wrel++, rel++;
7546 rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7547 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7548 rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7549
7550 /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7551 dynamic reloc. */
7552 r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7553 }
7554 else
7555 _bfd_error_handler
7556 /* xgettext:c-format */
7557 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7558 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7559 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7560 "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7561 }
7562 else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO
7563 && offset_in_range (input_section,
7564 rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
7565 {
7566 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7567 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7568 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7569 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7570 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7571 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7572 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7573 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7574 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7575 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7576 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7577 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7578 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7579 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7580 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7581 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7582 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7583 && (insn & 3) != 1)
7584 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7585 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7586 {
7587 /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7588 relocation = 0;
7589 unresolved_reloc = false;
7590 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7591 }
7592 else
7593 _bfd_error_handler
7594 /* xgettext:c-format */
7595 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7596 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7597 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7598 "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7599 }
7600 }
7601
7602 ifunc = NULL;
7603 if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
7604 {
7605 struct plt_entry *ent;
7606
7607 if (h != NULL)
7608 {
7609 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7610 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7611 }
7612 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7613 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7614 {
7615 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7616
7617 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7618 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7619 ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7620 }
7621
7622 ent = NULL;
7623 if (ifunc != NULL
7624 && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7625 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7626 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7627 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7628 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7629 {
7630 addend = 0;
7631 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7632 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7633 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7634 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7635 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7636 addend = rel->r_addend;
7637 ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7638 }
7639 if (ent != NULL)
7640 {
7641 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7642 && ent->sec != got2
7643 && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7644 && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7645 || h == NULL
7646 || h->dynindx == -1))
7647 {
7648 /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7649 for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7650 finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7651 apparently are using code compiled with
7652 -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7653 gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7654 whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7655 is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7656 into .got2). */
7657 info->callbacks->einfo
7658 /* xgettext:c-format */
7659 (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7660 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7661 }
7662
7663 unresolved_reloc = false;
7664 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7665 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7666 || h == NULL
7667 || h->dynindx == -1)
7668 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7669 + htab->glink->output_offset
7670 + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7671 else
7672 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7673 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7674 + ent->plt.offset);
7675 }
7676 }
7677
7678 addend = rel->r_addend;
7679 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7680 howto = NULL;
7681 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7682 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7683
7684 tls_type = 0;
7685 switch (r_type)
7686 {
7687 default:
7688 de_fault:
7689 if (howto)
7690 /* xgettext:c-format */
7691 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7692 input_bfd, howto->name);
7693 else
7694 /* xgettext:c-format */
7695 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: reloc %#x unsupported"),
7696 input_bfd, r_type);
7697
7698 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7699 ret = false;
7700 goto copy_reloc;
7701
7702 case R_PPC_NONE:
7703 case R_PPC_TLS:
7704 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7705 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7706 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7707 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7708 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7709 goto copy_reloc;
7710
7711 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7712 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7713 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7714 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7715 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7716 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7717 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7718 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7719 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7720 goto dogot;
7721
7722 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7723 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7724 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7725 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7726 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7727 goto dogot;
7728
7729 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7730 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7731 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7732 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7733 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7734 goto dogot;
7735
7736 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7737 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7738 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7739 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7740 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7741 goto dogot;
7742
7743 case R_PPC_GOT16:
7744 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7745 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7746 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7747 tls_mask = 0;
7748 dogot:
7749 {
7750 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7751 offset table. */
7752 bfd_vma off;
7753 bfd_vma *offp;
7754 unsigned long indx;
7755
7756 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7757 abort ();
7758
7759 indx = 0;
7760 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7761 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7762 offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7763 else if (h != NULL)
7764 {
7765 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7766 || h->dynindx == -1
7767 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7768 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7769 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7770 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7771 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7772 because of a version file. */
7773 ;
7774 else
7775 {
7776 indx = h->dynindx;
7777 unresolved_reloc = false;
7778 }
7779 offp = &h->got.offset;
7780 }
7781 else
7782 {
7783 if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7784 abort ();
7785 offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7786 }
7787
7788 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7789 least significant bit to record whether we have already
7790 processed this entry. */
7791 off = *offp;
7792 if ((off & 1) != 0)
7793 off &= ~1;
7794 else
7795 {
7796 unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7797 ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7798 | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7799 : 0);
7800
7801 if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7802 tls_m = TLS_LD;
7803 else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
7804 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7805 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7806
7807 /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7808 Initialize them all. */
7809 do
7810 {
7811 int tls_ty = 0;
7812
7813 if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7814 {
7815 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7816 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7817 }
7818 else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7819 {
7820 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7821 tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7822 }
7823 else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7824 {
7825 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7826 tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7827 }
7828 else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7829 {
7830 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7831 tls_m = 0;
7832 }
7833
7834 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7835 if (indx != 0
7836 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7837 && (h == NULL
7838 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7839 && !(tls_ty != 0
7840 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7841 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7842 && (h != NULL
7843 ? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
7844 : sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)))
7845 {
7846 asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7847
7848 if (ifunc != NULL)
7849 {
7850 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7851 if (indx == 0)
7852 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7853 else if (is_static_defined (h))
7854 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7855 }
7856 outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7857 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7858 + off);
7859 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7860 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7861 {
7862 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7863 if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7864 {
7865 BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd,
7866 &outrel,
7867 rsec));
7868 outrel.r_offset += 4;
7869 outrel.r_info
7870 = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7871 }
7872 }
7873 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7874 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7875 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7876 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7877 else if (indx != 0)
7878 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7879 else if (ifunc != NULL)
7880 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7881 else
7882 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7883 if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7884 {
7885 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7886 if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7887 {
7888 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7889 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7890 else
7891 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7892 }
7893 }
7894 BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd,
7895 &outrel, rsec));
7896 }
7897
7898 /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7899 emitting a reloc. */
7900 else
7901 {
7902 bfd_vma value = relocation;
7903
7904 if (tls_ty != 0)
7905 {
7906 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7907 value = 0;
7908 else
7909 {
7910 if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7911 value = 0;
7912 else
7913 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7914 if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7915 value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7916 }
7917
7918 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7919 {
7920 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7921 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7922 value = 1;
7923 }
7924 }
7925 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7926 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7927 }
7928
7929 off += 4;
7930 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7931 off += 4;
7932 }
7933 while (tls_m != 0);
7934
7935 off = *offp;
7936 *offp = off | 1;
7937 }
7938
7939 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7940 abort ();
7941
7942 if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7943 {
7944 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7945 {
7946 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7947 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7948 off += 8;
7949 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7950 {
7951 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7952 off += 8;
7953 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7954 {
7955 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7956 off += 4;
7957 }
7958 }
7959 }
7960 }
7961
7962 /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7963 if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7964 goto copy_reloc;
7965
7966 relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7967 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7968 + off
7969 - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7970
7971 /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7972 x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7973 generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7974 got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7975 if (addend != 0)
7976 info->callbacks->einfo
7977 /* xgettext:c-format */
7978 (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7979 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7980 howto->name,
7981 sym_name);
7982 }
7983 break;
7984
7985 /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7986 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7987 /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7988 at a symbol not in this object. */
7989 if (unresolved_reloc)
7990 {
7991 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7992 h->root.root.string,
7993 input_bfd,
7994 input_section,
7995 rel->r_offset,
7996 true);
7997 goto copy_reloc;
7998 }
7999 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
8000 {
8001 /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
8002 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
8003 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
8004 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
8005 access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
8006 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
8007 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
8008 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
8009 /* xgettext:c-format */
8010 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
8011 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8012 h->root.root.string);
8013 }
8014 break;
8015
8016 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8017 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8018 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
8019 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8020 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8021 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8022 break;
8023
8024 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
8025 object. */
8026 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8027 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8028 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8029 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8030 if (h != NULL
8031 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8032 && h->dynindx == -1
8033 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
8034 {
8035 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8036 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8037 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8038 defined before using them. */
8039 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8040 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8041 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8042 if (insn != 0)
8043 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8044 break;
8045 }
8046 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8047 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8048 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8049 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8050 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8051 goto dodyn;
8052
8053 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8054 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8055 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8056 goto dodyn;
8057
8058 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8059 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8060 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8061 goto dodyn;
8062
8063 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8064 relocation = 1;
8065 addend = 0;
8066 goto dodyn;
8067
8068 case R_PPC_REL16:
8069 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8070 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8071 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8072 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8073 break;
8074
8075 case R_PPC_REL32:
8076 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8077 break;
8078 /* fall through */
8079
8080 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8081 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8082 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8083 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8084 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8085 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8086 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8087 goto dodyn;
8088
8089 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8090 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8091 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8092 case R_PPC_REL24:
8093 case R_PPC_REL14:
8094 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8095 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8096 /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8097 handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8098 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8099 || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8100 break;
8101 /* fall through */
8102
8103 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8104 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8105 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8106 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8107 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8108 break;
8109 /* fall through */
8110
8111 dodyn:
8112 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8113 || is_vxworks_tls)
8114 break;
8115
8116 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8117 ? ((h == NULL
8118 || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8119 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8120 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8121 : (h != NULL
8122 && h->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8123 {
8124 int skip;
8125 asection *sreloc;
8126 long indx = 0;
8127
8128 #ifdef DEBUG
8129 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8130 "create relocation for %s\n",
8131 (h && h->root.root.string
8132 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8133 #endif
8134
8135 /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8136 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8137 time. */
8138 skip = 0;
8139 outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8140 input_section,
8141 rel->r_offset);
8142 if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8143 || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8144 skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8145 outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8146 + input_section->output_offset);
8147
8148 /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
8149 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8150 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8151 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8152 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8153 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8154 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8155
8156 if (skip)
8157 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8158 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8159 {
8160 indx = h->dynindx;
8161 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8162 unresolved_reloc = false;
8163 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8164 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8165 }
8166 else
8167 {
8168 outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8169
8170 if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8171 {
8172 if (ifunc != NULL)
8173 {
8174 /* If we get here when building a static
8175 executable, then the libc startup function
8176 responsible for applying indirect function
8177 relocations is going to complain about
8178 the reloc type.
8179 If we get here when building a dynamic
8180 executable, it will be because we have
8181 a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8182 will set the text segment writable and
8183 non-executable to apply text relocations.
8184 So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8185 indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8186 info->callbacks->einfo
8187 /* xgettext:c-format */
8188 (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8189 "function %s unsupported\n"),
8190 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8191 howto->name,
8192 sym_name);
8193 ret = false;
8194 }
8195 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8196 ;
8197 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8198 {
8199 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8200 ret = false;
8201 }
8202 else
8203 {
8204 asection *osec;
8205
8206 /* We are turning this relocation into one
8207 against a section symbol. It would be
8208 proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8209 osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8210 but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8211 FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8212 osec = sec->output_section;
8213 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8214 {
8215 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8216 indx = 0;
8217 }
8218 else
8219 {
8220 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8221 if (indx == 0)
8222 {
8223 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8224 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8225 }
8226 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8227 }
8228
8229 /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8230 Don't leave the symbol value in the
8231 addend for them. */
8232 if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8233 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8234 }
8235
8236 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8237 }
8238 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8239 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8240 else
8241 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8242 }
8243
8244 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8245 if (ifunc)
8246 {
8247 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8248 if (indx == 0)
8249 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8250 else if (is_static_defined (h))
8251 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8252 }
8253 if (sreloc == NULL)
8254 return false;
8255
8256 BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
8257 sreloc));
8258
8259 if (skip == -1)
8260 goto copy_reloc;
8261
8262 /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8263 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8264 if (!skip)
8265 {
8266 relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8267 addend = 0;
8268 break;
8269 }
8270 }
8271 break;
8272
8273 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8274 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8275 if (h != NULL)
8276 {
8277 struct plt_entry *ent;
8278 bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8279
8280 if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8281 {
8282 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8283 got2_addend = addend;
8284 addend = 0;
8285 }
8286 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8287 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8288 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8289 + htab->glink->output_offset
8290 + ent->glink_offset);
8291 else
8292 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8293 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8294 + ent->plt.offset);
8295 }
8296 /* Fall through. */
8297
8298 case R_PPC_RELAX:
8299 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8300 ? offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - 12,
8301 ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) * 4)
8302 : offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset,
8303 ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry) * 4))
8304 {
8305 const int *stub;
8306 size_t size;
8307 size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8308 unsigned int insn;
8309
8310 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8311 {
8312 relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8313 + input_section->output_offset
8314 + rel->r_offset - 4);
8315 stub = shared_stub_entry;
8316 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8317 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8318 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8319 stub += 3;
8320 size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8321 }
8322 else
8323 {
8324 stub = stub_entry;
8325 size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8326 }
8327
8328 relocation += addend;
8329 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8330 relocation = 0;
8331
8332 /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8333 insn = *stub++;
8334 insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8335 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8336 insn_offset += 4;
8337
8338 insn = *stub++;
8339 insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8340 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8341 insn_offset += 4;
8342 size -= 2;
8343
8344 while (size != 0)
8345 {
8346 insn = *stub++;
8347 --size;
8348 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8349 insn_offset += 4;
8350 }
8351
8352 /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8353 relocs to describe this relocation. */
8354 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8355 /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8356 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8357 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8358 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8359 memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8360 wrel++, rel++;
8361 wrel->r_offset += 4;
8362 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8363 }
8364 else
8365 goto de_fault;
8366 continue;
8367
8368 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8369 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8370 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8371 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8372 {
8373 unresolved_reloc = true;
8374 break;
8375 }
8376 relocation
8377 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8378 h, relocation, rel);
8379 addend = 0;
8380 break;
8381
8382 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8383 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8384 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8385 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8386 {
8387 unresolved_reloc = true;
8388 break;
8389 }
8390 relocation
8391 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8392 h, relocation, rel);
8393 addend = 0;
8394 break;
8395
8396 /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8397 section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8398 an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8399 AIX .toc section. */
8400 case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8401 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8402 {
8403 unresolved_reloc = true;
8404 break;
8405 }
8406 BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
8407 || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
8408
8409 addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8410 break;
8411
8412 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8413 if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8414 {
8415 struct plt_entry *ent;
8416
8417 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8418 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8419 if (ent == NULL
8420 || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8421 {
8422 /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8423 happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8424 using -Bsymbolic. */
8425 }
8426 else
8427 {
8428 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8429 procedure linkage table. */
8430 unresolved_reloc = false;
8431 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8432 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8433 + htab->glink->output_offset
8434 + ent->glink_offset);
8435 else
8436 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8437 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8438 + ent->plt.offset);
8439 }
8440 }
8441
8442 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8443 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8444 Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8445 addend = 0;
8446 break;
8447
8448 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8449 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8450 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8451 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8452 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8453 plt_list = NULL;
8454 if (h != NULL)
8455 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8456 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8457 plt_list = ifunc;
8458 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8459 {
8460 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8461 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8462 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8463 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8464 }
8465 unresolved_reloc = true;
8466 if (plt_list != NULL)
8467 {
8468 struct plt_entry *ent;
8469
8470 ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8471 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8472 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8473 {
8474 asection *plt;
8475
8476 unresolved_reloc = false;
8477 plt = htab->elf.splt;
8478 if (use_local_plt (info, h))
8479 {
8480 if (ifunc != NULL)
8481 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8482 else
8483 plt = htab->pltlocal;
8484 }
8485 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8486 + plt->output_offset
8487 + ent->plt.offset);
8488 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8489 {
8490 bfd_vma got = 0;
8491
8492 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8493 got = (ent->addend
8494 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8495 + ent->sec->output_offset);
8496 else
8497 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8498 relocation -= got;
8499 }
8500 }
8501 }
8502 addend = 0;
8503 break;
8504
8505 /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8506 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8507 {
8508 const char *name;
8509 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8510
8511 if (sec == NULL
8512 || sec->output_section == NULL
8513 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8514 {
8515 unresolved_reloc = true;
8516 break;
8517 }
8518 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8519
8520 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8521 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8522 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8523 {
8524 _bfd_error_handler
8525 /* xgettext:c-format */
8526 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8527 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8528 input_bfd,
8529 sym_name,
8530 howto->name,
8531 name);
8532 }
8533 }
8534 break;
8535
8536 /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8537 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8538 {
8539 const char *name;
8540 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8541
8542 if (sec == NULL
8543 || sec->output_section == NULL
8544 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8545 {
8546 unresolved_reloc = true;
8547 break;
8548 }
8549 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8550
8551 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8552 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8553 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8554 {
8555 _bfd_error_handler
8556 /* xgettext:c-format */
8557 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8558 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8559 input_bfd,
8560 sym_name,
8561 howto->name,
8562 name);
8563 }
8564 }
8565 break;
8566
8567 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8568 relocation = relocation + addend;
8569 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8570 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8571 split16a_type,
8572 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8573 goto report_reloc;
8574
8575 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8576 relocation = relocation + addend;
8577 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8578 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8579 split16d_type,
8580 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8581 goto report_reloc;
8582
8583 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8584 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8585 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8586 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8587 split16a_type,
8588 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8589 goto report_reloc;
8590
8591 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8592 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8593 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8594 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8595 split16d_type,
8596 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8597 goto report_reloc;
8598
8599 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8600 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8601 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8602 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8603 split16a_type,
8604 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8605 goto report_reloc;
8606
8607 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8608 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8609 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8610 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8611 split16d_type,
8612 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8613 goto report_reloc;
8614
8615 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8616 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8617 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8618 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8619 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8620 if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8621 {
8622 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8623 goto report_reloc;
8624 }
8625 else
8626 {
8627 const char *name;
8628 int reg;
8629 unsigned int insn;
8630 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8631
8632 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8633 {
8634 unresolved_reloc = true;
8635 break;
8636 }
8637
8638 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8639 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8640 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8641 {
8642 reg = 13;
8643 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8644 }
8645 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8646 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8647 {
8648 reg = 2;
8649 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8650 }
8651 else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8652 || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8653 {
8654 reg = 0;
8655 }
8656 else
8657 {
8658 _bfd_error_handler
8659 /* xgettext:c-format */
8660 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8661 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8662 input_bfd,
8663 sym_name,
8664 howto->name,
8665 name);
8666
8667 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8668 ret = false;
8669 goto copy_reloc;
8670 }
8671
8672 if (sda != NULL)
8673 {
8674 if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8675 {
8676 unresolved_reloc = true;
8677 break;
8678 }
8679 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8680 }
8681
8682 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8683 break;
8684
8685 /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8686 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8687 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8688 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8689 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8690 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8691 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8692 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8693 rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8694
8695 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8696 if (reg == 0
8697 && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8698 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8699 {
8700 relocation = relocation + addend;
8701 addend = 0;
8702
8703 /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8704 insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8705 insn |= 28u << 26;
8706
8707 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8708 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8709 insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8710 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8711 insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8712 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8713 insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8714
8715 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8716
8717 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
8718 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8719 && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8720 r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
8721 goto report_reloc;
8722 }
8723 /* Fill in register field. */
8724 insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8725 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8726 }
8727 break;
8728
8729 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8730 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8731 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8732 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8733 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8734 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8735 if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8736 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8737 else
8738 {
8739 bfd_vma value;
8740 const char *name;
8741 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8742
8743 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8744 {
8745 unresolved_reloc = true;
8746 break;
8747 }
8748
8749 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8750 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8751 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8752 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8753 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8754 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8755 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8756 else
8757 {
8758 _bfd_error_handler
8759 /* xgettext:c-format */
8760 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8761 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8762 input_bfd,
8763 sym_name,
8764 howto->name,
8765 name);
8766
8767 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8768 ret = false;
8769 goto copy_reloc;
8770 }
8771
8772 if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8773 {
8774 unresolved_reloc = true;
8775 break;
8776 }
8777 value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8778
8779 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8780 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8781 rel->r_offset,
8782 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8783 split16a_type,
8784 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8785 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8786 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8787 rel->r_offset,
8788 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8789 split16d_type,
8790 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8791 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8792 {
8793 value = value >> 16;
8794 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8795 rel->r_offset,
8796 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8797 split16a_type,
8798 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8799 }
8800 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8801 {
8802 value = value >> 16;
8803 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8804 rel->r_offset,
8805 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8806 split16d_type,
8807 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8808 }
8809 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8810 {
8811 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8812 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8813 rel->r_offset,
8814 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8815 split16a_type,
8816 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8817 }
8818 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8819 {
8820 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8821 r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
8822 rel->r_offset,
8823 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8824 split16d_type,
8825 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8826 }
8827 else
8828 abort ();
8829 }
8830 goto report_reloc;
8831
8832 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8833 if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8834 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8835 else
8836 {
8837 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset,
8838 relocation);
8839 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
8840 }
8841 goto report_reloc;
8842
8843 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8844 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8845 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8846 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8847 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8848 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8849 {
8850 unresolved_reloc = true;
8851 break;
8852 }
8853 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8854 break;
8855
8856 /* Negative relocations. */
8857 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8858 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8859 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8860 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8861 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8862 addend -= 2 * relocation;
8863 break;
8864
8865 case R_PPC_COPY:
8866 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8867 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8868 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8869 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8870 case R_PPC_PLT32:
8871 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8872 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8873 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8874 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8875 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8876 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8877 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8878 /* xgettext:c-format */
8879 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8880 input_bfd, howto->name);
8881
8882 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8883 ret = false;
8884 goto copy_reloc;
8885 }
8886
8887 switch (r_type)
8888 {
8889 default:
8890 break;
8891
8892 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8893 if (htab->do_tls_opt
8894 && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
8895 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8896
8897 {
8898 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8899 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8900 }
8901 break;
8902
8903 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8904 if (htab->do_tls_opt
8905 && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
8906 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8907 {
8908 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8909 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8910 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
8911 insn |= 2 << 16;
8912 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8913 }
8914 break;
8915 }
8916
8917 switch (r_type)
8918 {
8919 default:
8920 break;
8921
8922 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8923 if (unresolved_reloc)
8924 {
8925 if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
8926 {
8927 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8928 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8929 insn &= 1;
8930 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8931 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8932 r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8933 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8934 }
8935 }
8936 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8937 info->callbacks->einfo
8938 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8939 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8940 howto->name);
8941 break;
8942
8943 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8944 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8945 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8946 if (unresolved_reloc)
8947 {
8948 if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
8949 {
8950 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8951 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8952 unresolved_reloc = false;
8953 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8954 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8955 }
8956 }
8957 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8958 info->callbacks->einfo
8959 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8960 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8961 howto->name);
8962 break;
8963 }
8964
8965 /* Do any further special processing. */
8966 switch (r_type)
8967 {
8968 default:
8969 break;
8970
8971 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8972 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8973 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8974 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8975 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8976 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8977 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8978 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8979 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8980 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8981 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8982 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8983 if (sec == NULL)
8984 break;
8985 /* Fall through. */
8986
8987 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8988 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8989 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8990 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8991 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8992 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8993 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8994 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8995 addend += 0x8000;
8996 break;
8997
8998 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8999 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
9000 case R_PPC_GOT16:
9001 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
9002 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
9003 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
9004 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
9005 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
9006 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
9007 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
9008 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
9009 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
9010 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
9011 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
9012 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
9013 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
9014 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
9015 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
9016 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
9017 if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
9018 {
9019 /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
9020 certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
9021 that make up part of the insn opcode. */
9022 unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
9023
9024 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
9025 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
9026 mask = 0;
9027 if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
9028 mask = 3;
9029 else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
9030 mask = 15;
9031 else
9032 break;
9033 relocation += addend;
9034 addend = insn & mask;
9035 lobit = mask & relocation;
9036 if (lobit != 0)
9037 {
9038 relocation ^= lobit;
9039 info->callbacks->einfo
9040 /* xgettext:c-format */
9041 (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
9042 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9043 howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
9044 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9045 ret = false;
9046 }
9047 }
9048 break;
9049 }
9050
9051 #ifdef DEBUG
9052 fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
9053 "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
9054 howto->name,
9055 (int) r_type,
9056 sym_name,
9057 r_symndx,
9058 (long) rel->r_offset,
9059 (long) addend);
9060 #endif
9061
9062 if (unresolved_reloc
9063 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
9064 && h->def_dynamic)
9065 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
9066 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
9067 {
9068 info->callbacks->einfo
9069 /* xgettext:c-format */
9070 (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
9071 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9072 howto->name,
9073 sym_name);
9074 ret = false;
9075 }
9076
9077 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
9078 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
9079 have different reloc types. */
9080 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
9081 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
9082 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
9083 && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9084 {
9085 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
9086
9087 if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
9088 {
9089 unsigned int insn;
9090
9091 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
9092 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
9093 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
9094 else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
9095 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
9096 || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
9097 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
9098 }
9099 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9100 {
9101 alt_howto = *howto;
9102 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9103 howto = &alt_howto;
9104 }
9105 }
9106
9107 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9108 {
9109 /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9110 if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
9111 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9112 else
9113 {
9114 unsigned int insn;
9115
9116 relocation += addend;
9117 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9118 + input_section->output_offset
9119 + input_section->output_section->vma);
9120 relocation >>= 16;
9121 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9122 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9123 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9124 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9125 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9126 }
9127 }
9128 else
9129 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9130 rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9131
9132 report_reloc:
9133 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9134 {
9135 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9136 {
9137 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9138 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9139 if (!warned
9140 && !(h != NULL
9141 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9142 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9143 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9144 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9145 (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9146 rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9147 }
9148 else
9149 {
9150 info->callbacks->einfo
9151 /* xgettext:c-format */
9152 (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9153 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9154 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9155 ret = false;
9156 }
9157 }
9158 copy_reloc:
9159 if (wrel != rel)
9160 *wrel = *rel;
9161 }
9162
9163 if (wrel != rel)
9164 {
9165 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9166 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9167
9168 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9169 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9170 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9171 {
9172 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9173 one NONE reloc.
9174 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9175 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9176 deleted -= 1;
9177 wrel++;
9178 }
9179 relend = wrel;
9180 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9181 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9182 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9183 }
9184
9185 #ifdef DEBUG
9186 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9187 #endif
9188
9189 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9190 && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9191 && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9192 || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9193 {
9194 /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9195 unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9196 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9197 }
9198
9199 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9200 && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9201 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9202 || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9203 >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9204 {
9205 bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9206 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9207
9208 if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9209 {
9210 bfd_byte *p;
9211 unsigned int n;
9212 bfd_byte fill[4];
9213
9214 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9215 p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9216 n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9217 while (n--)
9218 {
9219 memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9220 p += 4;
9221 }
9222 }
9223
9224 /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9225 branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9226 branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9227 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9228 wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9229
9230 start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9231 + input_section->output_offset);
9232 end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9233 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9234 for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9235 addr < end_addr;
9236 addr += pagesize)
9237 {
9238 bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9239 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9240 bool is_data;
9241 bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9242 unsigned int insn;
9243
9244 /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9245 the word alone. */
9246 is_data = false;
9247 lo = relocs;
9248 hi = relend;
9249 rel = NULL;
9250 while (lo < hi)
9251 {
9252 rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9253 if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9254 lo = rel + 1;
9255 else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9256 hi = rel;
9257 else
9258 {
9259 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9260 {
9261 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9262 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9263 case R_PPC_REL32:
9264 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9265 is_data = true;
9266 break;
9267 default:
9268 break;
9269 }
9270 break;
9271 }
9272 }
9273 if (is_data)
9274 continue;
9275
9276 /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9277 branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9278 avoid the icache failure.
9279
9280 The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9281 where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9282 page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9283 instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9284 unconditional branches:
9285 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9286 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9287 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9288 where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9289 prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9290 affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9291 instruction is not executed.
9292
9293 A bctr example:
9294 .
9295 . lis 9,new_page@ha
9296 . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9297 . mtctr 9
9298 . bctr
9299 . nop
9300 . nop
9301 . new_page:
9302 .
9303 The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9304 ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9305 new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9306 fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9307 bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9308 prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9309 place:
9310 .
9311 . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9312 . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9313 . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9314 . bctr bctr
9315 . nop b somewhere_else
9316 . b somewhere_else nop
9317 . new_page: new_page:
9318 . */
9319 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9320 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9321 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9322 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9323 || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9324 && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9325 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9326 continue;
9327
9328 patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9329 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9330 patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9331 patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9332 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9333
9334 if (rel != NULL
9335 && rel->r_offset >= offset
9336 && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9337 {
9338 asection *sreloc;
9339
9340 /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9341 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9342 location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9343 if (rel + 1 != relend)
9344 {
9345 Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9346
9347 /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9348 memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9349 relend[-1] = tmp;
9350 }
9351 relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9352
9353 /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9354 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9355 {
9356 case R_PPC_REL16:
9357 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9358 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9359 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9360 relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9361 break;
9362 default:
9363 break;
9364 }
9365
9366 /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9367 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9368 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9369 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9370 if (sreloc != NULL)
9371 {
9372 Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9373 bfd_vma soffset;
9374
9375 slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9376 shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9377 soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9378 + input_section->output_offset);
9379 while (slo < shi)
9380 {
9381 Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9382 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9383 &outrel);
9384 if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9385 slo = srel + 1;
9386 else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9387 shi = srel;
9388 else
9389 {
9390 if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9391 {
9392 memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9393 (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9394 srel = srelend - 1;
9395 }
9396 outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9397 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9398 (bfd_byte *) srel);
9399 break;
9400 }
9401 }
9402 }
9403 }
9404 else
9405 rel = NULL;
9406
9407 if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9408 && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9409 {
9410 bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9411
9412 delta += offset - patch_off;
9413 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9414 delta = 0;
9415 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9416 {
9417 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9418
9419 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9420 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9421 insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9422 else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9423 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9424 else
9425 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9426
9427 if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9428 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9429 && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9430 && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9431 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9432 }
9433 if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9434 {
9435 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9436 (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9437 contents + patch_off);
9438 patch_off += 4;
9439 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9440 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9441 contents + patch_off);
9442 patch_off += 4;
9443 }
9444 else
9445 {
9446 if (rel != NULL)
9447 {
9448 unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9449
9450 relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9451 relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9452 }
9453 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9454 (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9455 contents + patch_off);
9456 patch_off += 4;
9457 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9458 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9459 contents + patch_off);
9460 patch_off += 4;
9461 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9462 B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9463 contents + patch_off);
9464 patch_off += 4;
9465 }
9466 }
9467 else
9468 {
9469 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9470 patch_off += 4;
9471 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9472 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9473 contents + patch_off);
9474 patch_off += 4;
9475 }
9476 BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9477 relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9478 }
9479 }
9480
9481 return ret;
9482 }
9483
9484 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9486
9487 static bool
9488 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9489 {
9490 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9491 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9492 struct plt_entry *ent;
9493 bool doneone;
9494
9495 doneone = false;
9496 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9497 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9498 {
9499 bool dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
9500
9501 if (!doneone)
9502 {
9503 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9504 bfd_byte *loc;
9505 bfd_vma reloc_index;
9506 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9507 asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9508
9509 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
9510 reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9511 else
9512 {
9513 reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9514 / htab->plt_slot_size);
9515 if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9516 && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9517 reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9518 }
9519
9520 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9521 Set it up. */
9522 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS && dyn)
9523 {
9524 bfd_vma got_offset;
9525 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9526
9527 /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9528 got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9529
9530 /* Use the right PLT. */
9531 plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9532 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9533
9534 /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9535 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9536 {
9537 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9538 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9539 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9540 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9541 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9542 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9543 }
9544 else
9545 {
9546 bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9547
9548 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9549 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9550 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9551 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9552 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9553 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9554 }
9555
9556 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9557 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9558 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9559 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9560
9561 /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9562 the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9563 start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9564 low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9565 /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9566 prescaled offset. */
9567 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9568 plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9569 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9570 /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9571 the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9572 instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9573 The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9574 stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9575 offset. */
9576 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9577 (plt_entry[5]
9578 | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9579 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9580 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9581 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9582 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9583 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9584
9585 /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9586 the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9587 in this PLT entry. */
9588 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9589 + plt->output_offset
9590 + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9591 htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9592
9593 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9594 {
9595 /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9596 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9597 + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9598 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9599 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9600
9601 /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9602 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9603 + plt->output_offset
9604 + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9605 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9606 R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9607 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9608 BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
9609 htab->srelplt2));
9610 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9611
9612 /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9613 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9614 + plt->output_offset
9615 + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9616 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9617 R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9618 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9619 BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
9620 htab->srelplt2));
9621 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9622
9623 /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9624 PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9625 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9626 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9627 + got_offset);
9628 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9629 R_PPC_ADDR32);
9630 rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9631 BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
9632 htab->srelplt2));
9633 }
9634
9635 /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9636 In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9637 address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9638 by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9639 the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9640 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9641 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9642 + got_offset);
9643 rela.r_addend = 0;
9644 }
9645 else
9646 {
9647 rela.r_addend = 0;
9648 if (!dyn)
9649 {
9650 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9651 {
9652 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9653 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9654 }
9655 else
9656 {
9657 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9658 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9659 }
9660 if (h->def_regular
9661 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9662 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9663 rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9664 }
9665
9666 if (relplt == NULL)
9667 {
9668 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9669 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9670 }
9671 else
9672 {
9673 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9674 + plt->output_offset
9675 + ent->plt.offset);
9676
9677 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD || !dyn)
9678 {
9679 /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9680 linker will fill it in. */
9681 }
9682 else
9683 {
9684 bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9685 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9686 + htab->glink->output_offset);
9687 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9688 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9689 }
9690 }
9691 }
9692
9693 if (relplt != NULL)
9694 {
9695 /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9696 if (!dyn)
9697 {
9698 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9699 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9700 else
9701 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9702 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9703 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9704 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9705 }
9706 else
9707 {
9708 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9709 loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9710 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9711 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9712 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9713 }
9714 BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela,
9715 loc, relplt));
9716 }
9717 doneone = true;
9718 }
9719
9720 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
9721 {
9722 unsigned char *p;
9723 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9724
9725 if (!dyn)
9726 {
9727 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9728 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9729 else
9730 break;
9731 }
9732
9733 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9734 write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9735
9736 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9737 /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9738 break;
9739 }
9740 else
9741 break;
9742 }
9743 return true;
9744 }
9745
9746 /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9747
9748 bool
9749 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9750 {
9751 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9752 bfd *ibfd;
9753
9754 if (!htab)
9755 return true;
9756
9757 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9758
9759 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9760 {
9761 bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9762 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9763 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9764 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9765 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9766 struct plt_entry *ent;
9767
9768 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9769 continue;
9770
9771 local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9772 if (!local_got)
9773 continue;
9774
9775 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9776 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9777 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9778 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9779 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9780 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9781 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9782 {
9783 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9784 {
9785 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9786 asection *sym_sec;
9787 asection *plt, *relplt;
9788 bfd_byte *loc;
9789 bfd_vma val;
9790 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9791 unsigned char *p;
9792
9793 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9794 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9795 {
9796 if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9797 free (local_syms);
9798 return false;
9799 }
9800
9801 val = sym->st_value;
9802 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9803 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9804
9805 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9806 {
9807 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9808 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9809 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9810 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9811 }
9812 else
9813 {
9814 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9815 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9816 {
9817 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9818 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9819 }
9820 else
9821 {
9822 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9823 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9824 continue;
9825 }
9826 }
9827
9828 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9829 + plt->output_offset
9830 + plt->output_section->vma);
9831 rela.r_addend = val;
9832 BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela,
9833 relplt));
9834
9835 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9836 write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9837 }
9838 }
9839
9840 if (local_syms != NULL
9841 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9842 {
9843 if (!info->keep_memory)
9844 free (local_syms);
9845 else
9846 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9847 }
9848 }
9849 return true;
9850 }
9851
9852 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9853 dynamic sections here. */
9854
9855 static bool
9856 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9857 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9858 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9859 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9860 {
9861 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9862 struct plt_entry *ent;
9863
9864 #ifdef DEBUG
9865 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9866 h->root.root.string);
9867 #endif
9868
9869 if (!h->def_regular
9870 || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9871 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9872 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9873 {
9874 if (!h->def_regular)
9875 {
9876 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9877 defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9878 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9879 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9880 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9881 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9882 to zero. */
9883 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9884 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9885 sym->st_value = 0;
9886 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9887 {
9888 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9889 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9890 function pointer. */
9891 sym->st_value = 0;
9892 }
9893 }
9894 else
9895 {
9896 /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9897 executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9898 text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9899 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9900 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9901 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9902 relocation. */
9903 sym->st_shndx
9904 = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9905 (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9906 sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9907 + htab->glink->output_offset
9908 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9909 }
9910 break;
9911 }
9912
9913 if (h->needs_copy)
9914 {
9915 asection *s;
9916 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9917
9918 /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9919
9920 #ifdef DEBUG
9921 fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9922 #endif
9923
9924 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9925
9926 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9927 s = htab->relsbss;
9928 else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9929 s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9930 else
9931 s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9932 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9933
9934 rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9935 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9936 rela.r_addend = 0;
9937 BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, s));
9938 }
9939
9940 #ifdef DEBUG
9941 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9942 #endif
9943
9944 return true;
9945 }
9946
9947 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9949 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9950 const asection *rel_sec,
9951 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9952 {
9953 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9954
9955 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9956 return reloc_class_ifunc;
9957
9958 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9959 {
9960 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9961 return reloc_class_relative;
9962 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9963 return reloc_class_plt;
9964 case R_PPC_COPY:
9965 return reloc_class_copy;
9966 default:
9967 return reloc_class_normal;
9968 }
9969 }
9970
9971 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9973
9974 static bool
9975 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9976 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9977 {
9978 asection *sdyn;
9979 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9980 bfd_vma got;
9981 bfd *dynobj;
9982 bool ret = true;
9983
9984 #ifdef DEBUG
9985 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9986 #endif
9987
9988 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9989 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9990 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9991
9992 got = 0;
9993 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9994 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9995
9996 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9997 {
9998 Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9999
10000 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
10001
10002 dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
10003 dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
10004 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
10005 {
10006 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
10007 asection *s;
10008
10009 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
10010
10011 switch (dyn.d_tag)
10012 {
10013 case DT_PLTGOT:
10014 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
10015 s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
10016 else
10017 s = htab->elf.splt;
10018 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10019 break;
10020
10021 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
10022 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
10023 break;
10024
10025 case DT_JMPREL:
10026 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
10027 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10028 break;
10029
10030 case DT_PPC_GOT:
10031 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
10032 break;
10033
10034 case DT_TEXTREL:
10035 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
10036 info->callbacks->einfo
10037 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
10038 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
10039 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
10040 info->callbacks->einfo
10041 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
10042 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
10043 continue;
10044
10045 default:
10046 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
10047 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
10048 break;
10049 continue;
10050 }
10051
10052 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
10053 }
10054 }
10055
10056 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
10057 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10058 {
10059 if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
10060 || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
10061 {
10062 unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
10063
10064 p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
10065 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
10066 {
10067 /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
10068 so that a function can easily find the address of
10069 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
10070 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
10071 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10072 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
10073 }
10074
10075 if (sdyn != NULL)
10076 {
10077 bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
10078 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
10079 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10080 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
10081 }
10082 }
10083 else
10084 {
10085 /* xgettext:c-format */
10086 _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
10087 htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
10088 (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
10089 ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
10090 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10091 ret = false;
10092 }
10093
10094 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10095 }
10096
10097 /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10098 if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
10099 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10100 && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10101 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10102 {
10103 asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10104 /* Use the right PLT. */
10105 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10106 ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10107 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10108
10109 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10110 {
10111 bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10112
10113 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10114 splt->contents + 0);
10115 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10116 splt->contents + 4);
10117 }
10118 else
10119 {
10120 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10121 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10122 }
10123 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10124 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10125 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10126 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10127 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10128 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10129
10130 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10131 {
10132 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10133 bfd_byte *loc;
10134
10135 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10136
10137 /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10138 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10139 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10140 + 2);
10141 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10142 rela.r_addend = 0;
10143 BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc, htab->srelplt2));
10144 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10145
10146 /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10147 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10148 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10149 + 6);
10150 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10151 rela.r_addend = 0;
10152 BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc, htab->srelplt2));
10153 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10154
10155 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10156 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10157 in which symbols were output. */
10158 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10159 {
10160 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10161
10162 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10163 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10164 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10165 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10166
10167 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10168 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10169 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10170 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10171
10172 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10173 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10174 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10175 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10176 }
10177 }
10178 }
10179
10180 if (htab->glink != NULL
10181 && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10182 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10183 {
10184 unsigned char *p;
10185 unsigned char *endp;
10186 bfd_vma res0;
10187
10188 /*
10189 * PIC glink code is the following:
10190 *
10191 * # ith PLT code stub.
10192 * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10193 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10194 * mtctr 11
10195 * bctr
10196 *
10197 * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10198 * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10199 * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10200 * res_0: b PLTresolve
10201 * res_1: b PLTresolve
10202 * .
10203 * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10204 * res_n_m3: nop
10205 * res_n_m2: nop
10206 * res_n_m1:
10207 *
10208 * PLTresolve:
10209 * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10210 * mflr 0
10211 * bcl 20,31,1f
10212 * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10213 * mflr 12
10214 * mtlr 0
10215 * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10216 * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10217 * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10218 * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10219 * mtctr 0
10220 * add 0,11,11
10221 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10222 * bctr
10223 *
10224 * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10225 *
10226 * # ith PLT code stub.
10227 * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10228 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10229 * mtctr 11
10230 * bctr
10231 *
10232 * The branch table is the same, then comes
10233 *
10234 * PLTresolve:
10235 * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10236 * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10237 * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10238 * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10239 * mtctr 0
10240 * add 0,11,11
10241 * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10242 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10243 * bctr
10244 */
10245
10246 /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10247 and perhaps some padding. */
10248 p = htab->glink->contents;
10249 p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10250 endp = htab->glink->contents;
10251 endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10252 while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10253 {
10254 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10255 p += 4;
10256 }
10257 while (p < endp)
10258 {
10259 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10260 p += 4;
10261 }
10262
10263 res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10264 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10265 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10266
10267 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10268 {
10269 /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10270 result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10271 glink branch table. */
10272 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10273 bfd_vma page_addr;
10274 bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10275 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10276
10277 for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10278 page_addr > glink_start;
10279 page_addr -= pagesize)
10280 {
10281 /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10282 bfd_byte *loc;
10283 unsigned int insn;
10284
10285 loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10286 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10287 if (insn == BCTR)
10288 {
10289 /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10290 one other call stub before this one. */
10291 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10292 if (insn == BCTR)
10293 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10294 else
10295 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10296 }
10297 }
10298 }
10299
10300 /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10301 endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10302 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10303 {
10304 bfd_vma bcl;
10305
10306 bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10307 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10308 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10309
10310 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10311 p += 4;
10312 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10313 p += 4;
10314 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10315 p += 4;
10316 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10317 p += 4;
10318 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10319 p += 4;
10320 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10321 p += 4;
10322 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10323 p += 4;
10324 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10325 p += 4;
10326 if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10327 {
10328 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10329 p += 4;
10330 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10331 p += 4;
10332 }
10333 else
10334 {
10335 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10336 p += 4;
10337 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10338 p += 4;
10339 }
10340 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10341 p += 4;
10342 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10343 }
10344 else
10345 {
10346 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10347 p += 4;
10348 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10349 p += 4;
10350 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10351 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10352 else
10353 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10354 p += 4;
10355 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10356 p += 4;
10357 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10358 p += 4;
10359 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10360 p += 4;
10361 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10362 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10363 else
10364 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10365 }
10366 p += 4;
10367 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10368 p += 4;
10369 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10370 p += 4;
10371 while (p < endp)
10372 {
10373 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10374 htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10375 p += 4;
10376 }
10377 BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10378 }
10379
10380 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10381 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10382 {
10383 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10384 bfd_vma val;
10385
10386 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10387 /* FDE length. */
10388 p += 4;
10389 /* CIE pointer. */
10390 p += 4;
10391 /* Offset to .glink. */
10392 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10393 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10394 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10395 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10396 val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10397 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10398
10399 if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10400 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10401 htab->glink_eh_frame,
10402 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10403 return false;
10404 }
10405
10406 return ret;
10407 }
10408
10409 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10411 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10412 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10413 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10414 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10415 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10416 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10417 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10418 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10419 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10420
10421 #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10422 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10423 #endif
10424
10425 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10426 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10427 #endif
10428
10429 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10430 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10431 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10432 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10433 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10434 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10435
10436 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10437 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10438 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10439 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10440 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10441 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10442 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10443 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10444
10445 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10446 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10447 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10448 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10449 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10450 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10451 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10452 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10453 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10454 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10455 #define elf_backend_late_size_sections ppc_elf_late_size_sections
10456 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10457 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10458 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10459 #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10460 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10461 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10462 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10463 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10464 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10465 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10466 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10467 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10468 #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10469 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10470 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10471 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10472 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10473 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10474
10475 #include "elf32-target.h"
10476
10477 /* FreeBSD Target */
10478
10479 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10480 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10481
10482 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10483 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10484 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10485 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10486
10487 #undef ELF_OSABI
10488 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10489
10490 #undef elf32_bed
10491 #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10492
10493 #include "elf32-target.h"
10494
10495 /* VxWorks Target */
10496
10497 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10498 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10499
10500 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10501 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10502 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10503 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10504
10505 #undef ELF_OSABI
10506
10507 #undef ELF_TARGET_OS
10508 #define ELF_TARGET_OS is_vxworks
10509
10510 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10511 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10512 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10513 {
10514 if (sec->name == NULL)
10515 return NULL;
10516
10517 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10518 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10519
10520 return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10521 }
10522
10523 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10524 appropriately for VxWorks. */
10525 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10526 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10527 {
10528 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10529
10530 ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10531 if (ret)
10532 {
10533 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10534 = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10535 htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10536 htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10537 htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10538 htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10539 }
10540 return ret;
10541 }
10542
10543 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10544 static bool
10545 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10546 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10547 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10548 const char **namep,
10549 flagword *flagsp,
10550 asection **secp,
10551 bfd_vma *valp)
10552 {
10553 if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10554 valp))
10555 return false;
10556
10557 return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10558 }
10559
10560 static bool
10561 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10562 {
10563 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10564 return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10565 }
10566
10567 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10568 define it. */
10569 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10570 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10571 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10572 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10573 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10574 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10575 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10576 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10577 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10578 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10579 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10580 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10581 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10582 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10583
10584 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10585
10586 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10587 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10588 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10589 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10590 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10591 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10592 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10593 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10594 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10595 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10596 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10597 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10598 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10599 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10600 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10601 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10602 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10603 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10604
10605 #undef elf32_bed
10606 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10607
10608 #include "elf32-target.h"
10609